PR debug/45003
[official-gcc/alias-decl.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobce35c9182e1e2f99033476de097b2ee9090d890d
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
6 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
7 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
9 This file is part of GCC.
11 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
12 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
13 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
14 version.
16 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
17 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
18 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
19 for more details.
21 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
23 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
39 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
40 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
41 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
42 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
43 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
45 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
46 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
48 CIE = Common Information Entry
49 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
51 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
53 FDE = Frame Description Entry
54 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
55 how to restore registers
57 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
58 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
60 #include "config.h"
61 #include "system.h"
62 #include "coretypes.h"
63 #include "tm.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "version.h"
66 #include "flags.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "libfuncs.h"
76 #include "except.h"
77 #include "dwarf2.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
80 #include "toplev.h"
81 #include "ggc.h"
82 #include "md5.h"
83 #include "tm_p.h"
84 #include "diagnostic.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92 #include "gimple.h"
93 #include "tree-pass.h"
94 #include "tree-flow.h"
96 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
97 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
99 static rtx last_var_location_insn;
100 #endif
102 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
103 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
105 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
106 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
107 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
108 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
109 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
110 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
111 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
112 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
113 #else
114 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
115 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
116 #endif
118 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
119 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
120 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
121 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
122 # else
123 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
124 # endif
125 #endif
127 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
128 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
129 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
130 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
131 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
132 #endif
134 /* Save the result of dwarf2out_do_frame across PCH. */
135 static GTY(()) bool saved_do_cfi_asm = 0;
137 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
138 translation unit. */
141 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
143 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
144 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
145 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
146 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
147 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
148 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO || saved_do_cfi_asm
149 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
150 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
151 && (flag_unwind_tables
152 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
153 #endif
157 /* Decide whether to emit frame unwind via assembler directives. */
160 dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm (void)
162 int enc;
164 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
165 return false;
166 #endif
167 if (!flag_dwarf2_cfi_asm || !dwarf2out_do_frame ())
168 return false;
169 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
170 return true;
171 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_PERSONALITY_DIRECTIVE)
172 return false;
174 /* Make sure the personality encoding is one the assembler can support.
175 In particular, aligned addresses can't be handled. */
176 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,/*global=*/1);
177 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
178 return false;
179 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,/*global=*/0);
180 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
181 return false;
183 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE)
185 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
186 return false;
187 #else
188 if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS || (!flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions))
189 return false;
190 #endif
193 saved_do_cfi_asm = true;
194 return true;
197 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
198 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
199 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
200 #endif
202 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
203 must be kept around forever. */
204 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
206 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
207 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
208 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
209 it. */
210 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
212 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
213 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
214 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
215 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
216 define type declaration DIE's. */
217 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
219 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
220 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
221 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
222 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
223 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
224 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
225 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
226 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
227 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
228 static GTY(()) section *debug_dcall_section;
229 static GTY(()) section *debug_vcall_section;
230 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
231 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
232 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
234 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
235 personality CFI. */
236 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
238 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
239 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
240 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
241 #endif
243 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
244 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
245 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
247 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
248 Information instructions. The register number, offset
249 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
250 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
252 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
253 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
254 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
255 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
256 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
257 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
260 typedef union GTY(()) dw_cfi_oprnd_struct {
261 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
262 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
263 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
264 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
266 dw_cfi_oprnd;
268 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_cfi_struct {
269 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
270 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
271 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
272 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
273 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
274 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
276 dw_cfi_node;
278 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
279 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
280 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
281 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
282 of this structure. */
283 typedef struct GTY(()) cfa_loc {
284 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
285 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
286 unsigned int reg;
287 BOOL_BITFIELD indirect : 1; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
288 BOOL_BITFIELD in_use : 1; /* 1 if a saved cfa is stored here. */
289 } dw_cfa_location;
291 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
292 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
293 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
294 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
295 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
297 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_fde_struct {
298 tree decl;
299 const char *dw_fde_begin;
300 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
301 const char *dw_fde_end;
302 const char *dw_fde_vms_end_prologue;
303 const char *dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue;
304 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
305 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
306 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
307 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
308 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
309 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_switch_cfi; /* Last CFI before switching sections. */
310 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_realignment;
311 unsigned funcdef_number;
312 /* Dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
313 unsigned int drap_reg;
314 /* Virtual dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
315 unsigned int vdrap_reg;
316 /* These 3 flags are copied from rtl_data in function.h. */
317 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
318 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
319 unsigned nothrow : 1;
320 /* Whether we did stack realign in this call frame. */
321 unsigned stack_realign : 1;
322 /* Whether dynamic realign argument pointer register has been saved. */
323 unsigned drap_reg_saved: 1;
324 /* True iff dw_fde_begin label is in text_section or cold_text_section. */
325 unsigned in_std_section : 1;
326 /* True iff dw_fde_unlikely_section_label is in text_section or
327 cold_text_section. */
328 unsigned cold_in_std_section : 1;
329 /* True iff switched sections. */
330 unsigned dw_fde_switched_sections : 1;
331 /* True iff switching from cold to hot section. */
332 unsigned dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot : 1;
334 dw_fde_node;
336 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
337 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
339 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
340 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
341 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
342 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
343 pointers. */
344 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
345 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
346 #endif
348 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
349 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
350 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
351 as PTR_SIZE. */
353 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
354 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
355 #endif
357 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF 4 type signature. */
359 #ifndef DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE
360 #define DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE 8
361 #endif
363 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
364 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
365 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
366 bytes.
368 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
369 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
371 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
372 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
373 #endif
375 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
376 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
377 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
379 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
380 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
381 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
382 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
383 #else
384 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
385 #endif
386 #endif
388 /* CIE identifier. */
389 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
390 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
391 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
392 #else
393 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
394 #endif
396 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
397 information for each routine. */
398 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
400 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
401 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
403 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
404 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
406 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
407 fde_table. */
408 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
410 /* Get the current fde_table entry we should use. */
412 static inline dw_fde_ref
413 current_fde (void)
415 return fde_table_in_use ? &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1] : NULL;
418 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
419 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
421 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
422 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
423 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
424 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
425 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
426 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
427 #endif
429 struct GTY(()) indirect_string_node {
430 const char *str;
431 unsigned int refcount;
432 enum dwarf_form form;
433 char *label;
436 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
438 /* True if the compilation unit has location entries that reference
439 debug strings. */
440 static GTY(()) bool debug_str_hash_forced = false;
442 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
443 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
445 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
446 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
448 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
450 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
451 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
453 /* The default cold text section. */
454 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
456 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
458 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
460 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
461 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
462 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
463 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
464 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
465 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *, dw_cfa_location *);
466 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
467 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
468 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
469 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
470 #endif
471 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
472 HOST_WIDE_INT);
473 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
474 static void output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref);
475 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
476 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
477 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
478 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx);
479 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
481 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
482 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
483 static void output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref);
484 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
485 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
486 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
487 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
488 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_aligned_loc
489 (HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT);
490 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
492 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
493 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
494 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
495 #endif
497 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
498 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
499 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
501 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
502 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
503 #endif
505 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
506 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
507 #endif
509 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
510 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
511 #endif
513 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
514 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
515 #endif
517 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
518 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
519 #endif
521 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
522 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
523 #endif
524 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
525 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
526 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
527 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
528 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
529 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
530 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
531 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
532 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
533 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
535 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
536 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
537 registers. */
538 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
539 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
540 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
541 #else
542 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
543 #endif
544 #endif
546 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
547 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
548 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
549 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
550 #endif
552 /* Hook used by __throw. */
555 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
557 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
558 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
561 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
562 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
564 static inline char *
565 stripattributes (const char *s)
567 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
568 char *p = stripped;
570 *p++ = '*';
572 while (*s && *s != ',')
573 *p++ = *s++;
575 *p = '\0';
576 return stripped;
579 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
580 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
582 static void
583 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
585 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
586 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
587 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
590 /* Divide OFF by DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, asserting no remainder. */
592 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
593 div_data_align (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
595 HOST_WIDE_INT r = off / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
596 gcc_assert (r * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == off);
597 return r;
600 /* Return true if we need a signed version of a given opcode
601 (e.g. DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf vs DW_CFA_offset_extended). */
603 static inline bool
604 need_data_align_sf_opcode (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
606 return DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT < 0 ? off > 0 : off < 0;
609 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
611 void
612 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
614 unsigned int i;
615 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
616 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
617 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
618 bool wrote_return_column = false;
620 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
622 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
624 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
626 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
627 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
628 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
630 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
631 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
632 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
634 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
635 continue;
636 wrote_return_column = true;
638 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
639 if (offset < 0)
640 continue;
642 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
643 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
647 if (!wrote_return_column)
648 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
650 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
651 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
652 #endif
654 targetm.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address);
657 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
659 static const char *
660 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
662 switch (cfi_opc)
664 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
665 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
666 case DW_CFA_offset:
667 return "DW_CFA_offset";
668 case DW_CFA_restore:
669 return "DW_CFA_restore";
670 case DW_CFA_nop:
671 return "DW_CFA_nop";
672 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
673 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
674 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
675 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
676 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
677 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
678 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
679 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
680 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
681 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
682 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
683 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
684 case DW_CFA_undefined:
685 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
686 case DW_CFA_same_value:
687 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
688 case DW_CFA_register:
689 return "DW_CFA_register";
690 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
691 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
692 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
693 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
694 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
695 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
696 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
697 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
698 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
699 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
701 /* DWARF 3 */
702 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
703 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
704 case DW_CFA_expression:
705 return "DW_CFA_expression";
706 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
707 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
708 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
709 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
710 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
711 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
713 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
714 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
715 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
717 /* GNU extensions */
718 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
719 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
720 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
721 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
722 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
723 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
725 default:
726 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
730 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
732 static inline dw_cfi_ref
733 new_cfi (void)
735 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc_dw_cfi_node ();
737 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
738 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
739 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
741 return cfi;
744 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
746 static inline void
747 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
749 dw_cfi_ref *p;
750 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
752 /* When DRAP is used, CFA is defined with an expression. Redefine
753 CFA may lead to a different CFA value. */
754 /* ??? Of course, this heuristic fails when we're annotating epilogues,
755 because of course we'll always want to redefine the CFA back to the
756 stack pointer on the way out. Where should we move this check? */
757 if (0 && fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
758 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
760 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
761 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
762 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
763 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
764 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
765 gcc_unreachable ();
767 default:
768 break;
771 /* Find the end of the chain. */
772 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
775 *p = cfi;
778 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. FORCE is true
779 if a label needs to be output even when using .cfi_* directives. */
781 char *
782 dwarf2out_cfi_label (bool force)
784 static char label[20];
786 if (!force && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
788 /* In this case, we will be emitting the asm directive instead of
789 the label, so just return a placeholder to keep the rest of the
790 interfaces happy. */
791 strcpy (label, "<do not output>");
793 else
795 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
796 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
799 return label;
802 /* True if remember_state should be emitted before following CFI directive. */
803 static bool emit_cfa_remember;
805 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
806 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
808 static void
809 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
811 dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
813 if (emit_cfa_remember)
815 dw_cfi_ref cfi_remember;
817 /* Emit the state save. */
818 emit_cfa_remember = false;
819 cfi_remember = new_cfi ();
820 cfi_remember->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_remember_state;
821 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi_remember);
824 list_head = &cie_cfi_head;
826 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
828 if (label)
830 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
832 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
834 /* We still have to add the cfi to the list so that lookup_cfa
835 works later on. When -g2 and above we even need to force
836 emitting of CFI labels and add to list a DW_CFA_set_loc for
837 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list purposes. If we're generating
838 DWARF3 output we use DW_OP_call_frame_cfa and so don't use
839 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
840 if (dwarf_version == 2
841 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
842 && (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
843 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG))
845 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
847 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
848 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
849 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
850 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
851 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
852 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
853 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
854 if (*label == 0 || strcmp (label, "<do not output>") == 0)
855 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (true);
857 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
858 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
860 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
862 label = xstrdup (label);
864 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
865 xcfi = new_cfi ();
866 /* It doesn't metter whether DW_CFA_set_loc
867 or DW_CFA_advance_loc4 is added here, those aren't
868 emitted into assembly, only looked up by
869 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
870 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_set_loc;
871 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
872 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
873 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
875 break;
876 default:
877 break;
881 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
883 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
885 /* ??? If this is a CFI for the CIE, we don't emit. This
886 assumes that the standard CIE contents that the assembler
887 uses matches the standard CIE contents that the compiler
888 uses. This is probably a bad assumption. I'm not quite
889 sure how to address this for now. */
891 else if (label)
893 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
895 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
897 if (*label == 0)
898 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
900 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
901 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
903 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
905 label = xstrdup (label);
907 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
908 xcfi = new_cfi ();
909 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
910 set the location directly using set_loc. */
911 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
912 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
913 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
914 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
915 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
917 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
920 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
923 add_cfi (list_head, cfi);
926 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
928 static void
929 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc, dw_cfa_location *remember)
931 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
933 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
934 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
935 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
936 break;
937 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
938 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
939 break;
940 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
941 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
942 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
943 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
944 break;
945 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
946 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
947 break;
949 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
950 gcc_assert (!remember->in_use);
951 *remember = *loc;
952 remember->in_use = 1;
953 break;
954 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
955 gcc_assert (remember->in_use);
956 *loc = *remember;
957 remember->in_use = 0;
958 break;
960 default:
961 break;
965 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
967 static void
968 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
970 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
971 dw_fde_ref fde;
972 dw_cfa_location remember;
974 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
975 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
976 remember = *loc;
978 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
979 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
981 fde = current_fde ();
982 if (fde)
983 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
984 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
987 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
988 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
990 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
991 from the CFA. */
992 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
994 /* The current save location around an epilogue. */
995 static dw_cfa_location cfa_remember;
997 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
998 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
1000 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
1001 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
1003 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
1004 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
1005 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
1007 void
1008 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1010 dw_cfa_location loc;
1011 loc.indirect = 0;
1012 loc.base_offset = 0;
1013 loc.reg = reg;
1014 loc.offset = offset;
1015 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
1018 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
1020 static bool
1021 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
1023 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
1024 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
1025 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
1026 && (loc1->indirect == 0
1027 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
1030 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
1031 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
1033 static void
1034 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
1036 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1037 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
1039 cfa = *loc_p;
1040 loc = *loc_p;
1042 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
1043 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
1045 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
1046 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
1048 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
1049 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
1050 return;
1052 cfi = new_cfi ();
1054 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect && !old_cfa.indirect)
1056 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
1057 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. The data
1058 factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf happens in output_cfi, or
1059 in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa_offset directive. */
1060 if (loc.offset < 0)
1061 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
1062 else
1063 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
1064 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1067 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
1068 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
1069 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
1070 && !loc.indirect
1071 && !old_cfa.indirect)
1073 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
1074 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
1075 offset has not changed. */
1076 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
1077 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1079 #endif
1081 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
1083 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
1084 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
1085 the specified offset. The data factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
1086 happens in output_cfi, or in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa
1087 directive. */
1088 if (loc.offset < 0)
1089 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
1090 else
1091 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
1092 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1093 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1095 else
1097 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
1098 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
1099 register-offset pair is available. */
1100 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
1102 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
1103 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
1104 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
1107 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1110 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
1111 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
1112 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
1113 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
1115 static void
1116 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1118 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1119 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
1121 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1123 /* When stack is aligned, store REG using DW_CFA_expression with
1124 FP. */
1125 if (fde
1126 && fde->stack_realign
1127 && sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1129 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
1130 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1131 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc
1132 = build_cfa_aligned_loc (offset, fde->stack_realignment);
1134 else if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1136 if (need_data_align_sf_opcode (offset))
1137 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
1138 else if (reg & ~0x3f)
1139 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
1140 else
1141 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
1142 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
1144 else if (sreg == reg)
1145 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
1146 else
1148 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
1149 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
1152 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1155 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
1156 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
1157 from the previous frame's window save area.
1159 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
1160 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
1162 void
1163 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
1165 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1167 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
1168 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1171 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
1172 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1174 void
1175 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1177 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1180 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
1181 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1183 void
1184 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1186 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1189 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
1190 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
1192 void
1193 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
1195 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
1198 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
1199 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
1200 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
1202 static void
1203 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
1205 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1206 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1208 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1210 case REG:
1211 /* RA is in a register. */
1212 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
1213 break;
1215 case MEM:
1216 /* RA is on the stack. */
1217 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
1218 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1220 case REG:
1221 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1222 offset = 0;
1223 break;
1225 case PLUS:
1226 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1227 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1228 break;
1230 case MINUS:
1231 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1232 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1233 break;
1235 default:
1236 gcc_unreachable ();
1239 break;
1241 case PLUS:
1242 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1243 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1244 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1245 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
1246 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1247 return;
1249 default:
1250 gcc_unreachable ();
1253 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1254 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1256 #endif
1258 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1259 contains. */
1261 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1262 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1263 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_offset)
1265 const_rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1266 const_rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1267 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1268 enum rtx_code code;
1270 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1272 code = GET_CODE (src);
1274 /* Assume (set (reg sp) (reg whatever)) sets args_size
1275 level to 0. */
1276 if (code == REG && src != stack_pointer_rtx)
1278 offset = -cur_args_size;
1279 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1280 offset = -offset;
1281 #endif
1282 return offset - cur_offset;
1285 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1286 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1287 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
1288 return 0;
1290 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1291 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1292 if (code == PLUS)
1293 offset = -offset;
1294 return offset;
1297 if (MEM_P (src) && !MEM_P (dest))
1298 dest = src;
1299 if (MEM_P (dest))
1301 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1302 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1303 code = GET_CODE (src);
1305 switch (code)
1307 case PRE_MODIFY:
1308 case POST_MODIFY:
1309 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1311 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1312 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1313 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1314 && CONST_INT_P (val));
1315 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1316 break;
1318 return 0;
1320 case PRE_DEC:
1321 case POST_DEC:
1322 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1324 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1325 break;
1327 return 0;
1329 case PRE_INC:
1330 case POST_INC:
1331 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1333 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1334 break;
1336 return 0;
1338 default:
1339 return 0;
1342 else
1343 return 0;
1345 return offset;
1348 /* Precomputed args_size for CODE_LABELs and BARRIERs preceeding them,
1349 indexed by INSN_UID. */
1351 static HOST_WIDE_INT *barrier_args_size;
1353 /* Helper function for compute_barrier_args_size. Handle one insn. */
1355 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1356 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1357 VEC (rtx, heap) **next)
1359 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1360 int i;
1362 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1364 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1365 /* Nothing */;
1366 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1367 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), cur_args_size, 0);
1368 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1369 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1371 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1372 for them. */
1373 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1374 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1375 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1376 cur_args_size, offset);
1379 else
1381 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1383 if (expr)
1385 expr = XEXP (expr, 0);
1386 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL
1387 || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1388 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (expr, 0); i++)
1390 rtx elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, i);
1392 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
1393 offset += stack_adjust_offset (elem, cur_args_size, offset);
1398 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1399 offset = -offset;
1400 #endif
1402 cur_args_size += offset;
1403 if (cur_args_size < 0)
1404 cur_args_size = 0;
1406 if (JUMP_P (insn))
1408 rtx dest = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
1410 if (dest)
1412 if (barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] < 0)
1414 barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] = cur_args_size;
1415 VEC_safe_push (rtx, heap, *next, dest);
1420 return cur_args_size;
1423 /* Walk the whole function and compute args_size on BARRIERs. */
1425 static void
1426 compute_barrier_args_size (void)
1428 int max_uid = get_max_uid (), i;
1429 rtx insn;
1430 VEC (rtx, heap) *worklist, *next, *tmp;
1432 barrier_args_size = XNEWVEC (HOST_WIDE_INT, max_uid);
1433 for (i = 0; i < max_uid; i++)
1434 barrier_args_size[i] = -1;
1436 worklist = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1437 next = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1438 insn = get_insns ();
1439 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = 0;
1440 VEC_quick_push (rtx, worklist, insn);
1441 for (;;)
1443 while (!VEC_empty (rtx, worklist))
1445 rtx prev, body, first_insn;
1446 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size;
1448 first_insn = insn = VEC_pop (rtx, worklist);
1449 cur_args_size = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1450 prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
1451 if (prev && BARRIER_P (prev))
1452 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (prev)] = cur_args_size;
1454 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1456 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
1457 continue;
1458 if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1459 break;
1461 if (LABEL_P (insn))
1463 if (insn == first_insn)
1464 continue;
1465 else if (barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] < 0)
1467 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = cur_args_size;
1468 continue;
1470 else
1472 /* The insns starting with this label have been
1473 already scanned or are in the worklist. */
1474 break;
1478 body = PATTERN (insn);
1479 if (GET_CODE (body) == SEQUENCE)
1481 HOST_WIDE_INT dest_args_size = cur_args_size;
1482 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1483 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0))
1484 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)))
1485 dest_args_size
1486 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1487 dest_args_size, &next);
1488 else
1489 cur_args_size
1490 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1491 cur_args_size, &next);
1493 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0)))
1494 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1495 dest_args_size, &next);
1496 else
1497 cur_args_size
1498 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1499 cur_args_size, &next);
1501 else
1502 cur_args_size
1503 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (insn, cur_args_size, &next);
1507 if (VEC_empty (rtx, next))
1508 break;
1510 /* Swap WORKLIST with NEXT and truncate NEXT for next iteration. */
1511 tmp = next;
1512 next = worklist;
1513 worklist = tmp;
1514 VEC_truncate (rtx, next, 0);
1517 VEC_free (rtx, heap, worklist);
1518 VEC_free (rtx, heap, next);
1521 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
1522 pushed onto the stack. */
1524 static void
1525 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1527 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1529 if (size == old_args_size)
1530 return;
1532 old_args_size = size;
1534 cfi = new_cfi ();
1535 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
1536 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
1537 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1540 /* Record a stack adjustment of OFFSET bytes. */
1542 static void
1543 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, const char *label)
1545 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1546 cfa.offset += offset;
1548 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1549 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1551 if (ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1552 return;
1554 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1555 offset = -offset;
1556 #endif
1558 args_size += offset;
1559 if (args_size < 0)
1560 args_size = 0;
1562 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1563 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1564 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1567 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1568 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out
1569 how much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1571 static void
1572 dwarf2out_notice_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1574 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1575 const char *label;
1576 int i;
1578 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1579 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1580 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1581 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1582 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1583 return;
1585 /* If INSN is an instruction from target of an annulled branch, the
1586 effects are for the target only and so current argument size
1587 shouldn't change at all. */
1588 if (final_sequence
1589 && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0))
1590 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (insn))
1591 return;
1593 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1594 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1595 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1597 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1599 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1600 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1601 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1602 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1603 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1604 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1605 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1606 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1608 return;
1611 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1613 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1614 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1615 return;
1617 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1619 /* Don't call compute_barrier_args_size () if the only
1620 BARRIER is at the end of function. */
1621 if (barrier_args_size == NULL && next_nonnote_insn (insn))
1622 compute_barrier_args_size ();
1623 if (barrier_args_size == NULL)
1624 offset = 0;
1625 else
1627 offset = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1628 if (offset < 0)
1629 offset = 0;
1632 offset -= args_size;
1633 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1634 offset = -offset;
1635 #endif
1637 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1638 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), args_size, 0);
1639 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1640 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1642 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1643 for them. */
1644 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1645 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1646 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1647 args_size, offset);
1649 else
1650 return;
1652 if (offset == 0)
1653 return;
1655 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
1656 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (offset, label);
1659 #endif
1661 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1662 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1663 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1665 struct GTY(()) queued_reg_save {
1666 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1667 rtx reg;
1668 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1669 rtx saved_reg;
1672 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1674 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1675 struct GTY(()) reg_saved_in_data {
1676 rtx orig_reg;
1677 rtx saved_in_reg;
1680 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1681 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1682 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1683 more efficient data structure. */
1684 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1685 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1687 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1688 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1690 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1691 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1693 static void
1694 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1696 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1698 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1699 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1700 order. */
1701 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1702 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1703 break;
1705 if (q == NULL)
1707 q = ggc_alloc_queued_reg_save ();
1708 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1709 queued_reg_saves = q;
1712 q->reg = reg;
1713 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1714 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1716 last_reg_save_label = label;
1719 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1721 static void
1722 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1724 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1726 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1728 size_t i;
1729 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1731 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1732 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1733 break;
1734 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1736 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1737 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1739 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1741 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1742 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1745 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1746 if (q->saved_reg)
1747 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1748 else
1749 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1750 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1753 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1754 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1757 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1758 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1759 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1760 have a new location for? */
1762 static bool
1763 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn)
1765 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1767 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1769 size_t i;
1770 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1771 return true;
1772 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1773 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1774 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1775 return true;
1778 return false;
1781 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1783 void
1784 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1786 size_t i;
1787 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1789 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1790 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1791 break;
1792 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1794 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1795 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1797 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1798 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1800 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1801 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1802 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1805 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1807 static rtx
1808 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1810 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1811 size_t i;
1812 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1814 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1815 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1816 return q->reg;
1818 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1819 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1820 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1821 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1823 return NULL_RTX;
1827 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1828 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1829 value, not an offset. */
1830 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1832 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_DEF_CFA note. */
1834 static void
1835 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1837 memset (&cfa, 0, sizeof (cfa));
1839 switch (GET_CODE (pat))
1841 case PLUS:
1842 cfa.reg = REGNO (XEXP (pat, 0));
1843 cfa.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1844 break;
1846 case REG:
1847 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1848 break;
1850 default:
1851 /* Recurse and define an expression. */
1852 gcc_unreachable ();
1855 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1858 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_ADJUST_CFA note. */
1860 static void
1861 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1863 rtx src, dest;
1865 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pat) == SET);
1866 dest = XEXP (pat, 0);
1867 src = XEXP (pat, 1);
1869 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1871 case PLUS:
1872 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1873 cfa.offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1874 break;
1876 case REG:
1877 break;
1879 default:
1880 gcc_unreachable ();
1883 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1884 gcc_assert (cfa.indirect == 0);
1886 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1889 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_OFFSET note. */
1891 static void
1892 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (rtx set, const char *label)
1894 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1895 rtx src, addr, span;
1897 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1898 addr = XEXP (set, 0);
1899 gcc_assert (MEM_P (addr));
1900 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
1902 /* As documented, only consider extremely simple addresses. */
1903 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
1905 case REG:
1906 gcc_assert (REGNO (addr) == cfa.reg);
1907 offset = -cfa.offset;
1908 break;
1909 case PLUS:
1910 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1911 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1)) - cfa.offset;
1912 break;
1913 default:
1914 gcc_unreachable ();
1917 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
1919 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1920 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1921 if (!span)
1922 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src)), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1923 else
1925 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC live.
1926 Queue register saves for each piece of the PARALLEL. */
1927 int par_index;
1928 int limit;
1929 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
1931 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
1933 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
1934 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1936 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
1938 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (elem)),
1939 INVALID_REGNUM, span_offset);
1940 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
1945 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_REGISTER note. */
1947 static void
1948 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (rtx set, const char *label)
1950 rtx src, dest;
1951 unsigned sregno, dregno;
1953 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1954 dest = XEXP (set, 0);
1956 if (src == pc_rtx)
1957 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
1958 else
1959 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
1961 dregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
1963 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1964 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1965 reg_save (label, sregno, dregno, 0);
1968 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_RESTORE note. */
1970 static void
1971 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (rtx reg, const char *label)
1973 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1974 unsigned int regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1976 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = (regno & ~0x3f ? DW_CFA_restore_extended : DW_CFA_restore);
1977 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = regno;
1979 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1982 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1983 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1984 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1985 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1987 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1988 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1989 users need not read the source code.
1991 The High-Level Picture
1993 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1994 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1995 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1996 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1997 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1999 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
2000 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
2001 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
2002 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
2003 saves. This also seems to work.
2005 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
2006 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
2007 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
2008 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
2009 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
2010 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
2011 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
2012 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
2013 value as in the caller.
2015 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
2016 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
2017 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
2018 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
2020 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
2021 register,
2023 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
2025 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
2026 consists of a register and an offset.
2027 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
2028 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
2029 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
2030 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
2031 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
2032 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
2033 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
2035 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
2036 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
2037 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
2038 cfa_temp.offset.
2040 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
2041 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
2042 and cfa_temp.offset.
2044 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
2045 stack.
2047 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
2048 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
2049 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
2051 Rules 16-20: If AND operation happens on sp in prologue, we assume
2052 stack is realigned. We will use a group of DW_OP_XXX
2053 expressions to represent the location of the stored
2054 register instead of CFA+offset.
2056 The Rules
2058 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
2059 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
2061 Rule 1:
2062 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
2063 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2064 cfa.offset unchanged
2065 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2066 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2068 Rule 2:
2069 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
2070 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
2071 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
2072 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
2073 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
2074 if cfa_store.reg==sp
2076 Rule 3:
2077 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2078 effects: cfa.reg = fp
2079 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
2081 Rule 4:
2082 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2083 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2084 <reg1> != sp
2085 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2086 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2087 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2089 Rule 5:
2090 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
2091 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2092 <reg1> != sp
2093 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
2094 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
2096 Rule 6:
2097 (set <reg> <const_int>)
2098 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2099 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2101 Rule 7:
2102 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
2103 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2104 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
2106 Rule 8:
2107 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
2108 effects: none
2110 Rule 9:
2111 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
2112 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2113 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2115 Rule 10:
2116 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
2117 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
2118 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2119 cfa.reg = sp
2120 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2122 Rule 11:
2123 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
2124 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2125 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2126 cfa.reg = sp
2127 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2129 Rule 12:
2130 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
2132 <reg2>)
2133 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2134 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2136 Rule 13:
2137 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
2138 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2139 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2141 Rule 14:
2142 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
2143 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2144 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
2145 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
2147 Rule 15:
2148 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
2149 effects: target-dependent
2151 Rule 16:
2152 (set sp (and: sp <const_int>))
2153 constraints: cfa_store.reg == sp
2154 effects: current_fde.stack_realign = 1
2155 cfa_store.offset = 0
2156 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg if cfa.reg != sp and cfa.reg != fp
2158 Rule 17:
2159 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) (mem (plus (cfa.reg) (const_int))))
2160 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2162 Rule 18:
2163 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) fp)
2164 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2165 effects: cfa_store.offset = 0
2166 cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2168 Rule 19:
2169 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) cfa.reg)
2170 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2171 && cfa.offset == 0
2172 && cfa.indirect == 0
2173 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2174 effects: Use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression to define cfa
2175 cfa.reg == fde->drap_reg */
2177 static void
2178 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
2180 rtx src, dest, span;
2181 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
2182 dw_fde_ref fde;
2184 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
2185 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
2186 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
2187 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
2188 flag is set in them. */
2189 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2191 int par_index;
2192 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
2193 rtx elem;
2195 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
2196 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
2197 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
2198 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
2199 handle register saves before register assignments. */
2200 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
2201 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2203 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2204 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2205 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
2206 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2207 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2210 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2212 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2213 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2214 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2215 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2216 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2217 else if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2218 && par_index != 0
2219 && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
2221 /* Stack adjustment combining might combine some post-prologue
2222 stack adjustment into a prologue stack adjustment. */
2223 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = stack_adjust_offset (elem, args_size, 0);
2225 if (offset != 0)
2226 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (offset, label);
2229 return;
2232 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
2234 src = SET_SRC (expr);
2235 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
2237 if (REG_P (src))
2239 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
2240 if (rsi)
2241 src = rsi;
2244 fde = current_fde ();
2246 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
2248 case REG:
2249 switch (GET_CODE (src))
2251 /* Setting FP from SP. */
2252 case REG:
2253 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
2255 /* Rule 1 */
2256 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
2257 relative to the current CFA register.
2259 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
2260 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
2261 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
2262 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
2263 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2264 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2265 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2267 else
2269 /* Saving a register in a register. */
2270 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
2271 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
2272 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
2273 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
2275 /* After stack is aligned, we can only save SP in FP
2276 if drap register is used. In this case, we have
2277 to restore stack pointer with the CFA value and we
2278 don't generate this DWARF information. */
2279 if (fde
2280 && fde->stack_realign
2281 && REGNO (src) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2282 gcc_assert (REGNO (dest) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2283 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
2284 && cfa.reg != REGNO (src));
2285 else
2286 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
2288 break;
2290 case PLUS:
2291 case MINUS:
2292 case LO_SUM:
2293 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
2295 /* Rule 2 */
2296 /* Adjusting SP. */
2297 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
2299 case CONST_INT:
2300 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2301 break;
2302 case REG:
2303 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
2304 == cfa_temp.reg);
2305 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
2306 break;
2307 default:
2308 gcc_unreachable ();
2311 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2313 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
2314 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2315 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2317 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
2318 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
2320 else
2321 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
2323 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2324 offset = -offset;
2325 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2326 cfa.offset += offset;
2327 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2328 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2330 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2332 /* Rule 3 */
2333 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
2334 or adjusting the FP */
2335 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
2337 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2338 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2339 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2340 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2341 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2342 offset = -offset;
2343 cfa.offset += offset;
2344 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2346 else
2348 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
2350 /* Rule 4 */
2351 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2352 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2353 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2355 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
2356 into the FP later on. */
2357 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2358 cfa.offset += offset;
2359 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2360 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
2361 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2362 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2365 /* Rule 5 */
2366 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2367 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2368 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2370 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
2371 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
2372 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2373 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
2374 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
2377 /* Rule 9 */
2378 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
2379 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2381 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2382 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2384 else
2385 gcc_unreachable ();
2387 break;
2389 /* Rule 6 */
2390 case CONST_INT:
2391 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2392 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
2393 break;
2395 /* Rule 7 */
2396 case IOR:
2397 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2398 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2399 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2401 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
2402 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2403 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2404 break;
2406 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
2407 which will fill in all of the bits. */
2408 /* Rule 8 */
2409 case HIGH:
2410 break;
2412 /* Rule 15 */
2413 case UNSPEC:
2414 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
2415 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
2416 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
2417 return;
2419 /* Rule 16 */
2420 case AND:
2421 /* If this AND operation happens on stack pointer in prologue,
2422 we assume the stack is realigned and we extract the
2423 alignment. */
2424 if (fde && XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2426 gcc_assert (cfa_store.reg == REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)));
2427 fde->stack_realign = 1;
2428 fde->stack_realignment = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2429 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2431 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2432 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2433 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg;
2435 return;
2437 default:
2438 gcc_unreachable ();
2441 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2442 break;
2444 case MEM:
2446 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
2447 CFA register. */
2448 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
2450 /* Rule 10 */
2451 /* With a push. */
2452 case PRE_MODIFY:
2453 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
2454 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
2455 == CONST_INT);
2456 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
2458 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2459 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2461 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2462 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2463 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2465 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2466 break;
2468 /* Rule 11 */
2469 case PRE_INC:
2470 case PRE_DEC:
2471 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2472 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
2473 offset = -offset;
2475 gcc_assert ((REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0))
2476 == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2477 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2479 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2481 /* Rule 18: If stack is aligned, we will use FP as a
2482 reference to represent the address of the stored
2483 regiser. */
2484 if (fde
2485 && fde->stack_realign
2486 && src == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2488 gcc_assert (cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2489 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2492 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2493 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2495 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2496 break;
2498 /* Rule 12 */
2499 /* With an offset. */
2500 case PLUS:
2501 case MINUS:
2502 case LO_SUM:
2504 int regno;
2506 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1))
2507 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2508 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
2509 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
2510 offset = -offset;
2512 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
2514 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2515 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
2516 else
2518 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2519 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
2522 break;
2524 /* Rule 13 */
2525 /* Without an offset. */
2526 case REG:
2528 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
2530 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2531 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2532 else
2534 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2535 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2538 break;
2540 /* Rule 14 */
2541 case POST_INC:
2542 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
2543 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2544 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2545 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2546 break;
2548 default:
2549 gcc_unreachable ();
2552 /* Rule 17 */
2553 /* If the source operand of this MEM operation is not a
2554 register, basically the source is return address. Here
2555 we only care how much stack grew and we don't save it. */
2556 if (!REG_P (src))
2557 break;
2559 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2560 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2561 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
2563 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
2565 if (cfa.offset == 0)
2567 /* Rule 19 */
2568 /* If stack is aligned, putting CFA reg into stack means
2569 we can no longer use reg + offset to represent CFA.
2570 Here we use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instead. The
2571 result of this expression equals to the original CFA
2572 value. */
2573 if (fde
2574 && fde->stack_realign
2575 && cfa.indirect == 0
2576 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2578 dw_cfa_location cfa_exp;
2580 gcc_assert (fde->drap_reg == cfa.reg);
2582 cfa_exp.indirect = 1;
2583 cfa_exp.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2584 cfa_exp.base_offset = offset;
2585 cfa_exp.offset = 0;
2587 fde->drap_reg_saved = 1;
2589 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa_exp);
2590 break;
2593 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
2594 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
2595 on the ARM. */
2596 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2597 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
2598 break;
2600 else
2602 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
2603 calculate the CFA. */
2604 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
2606 if (!REG_P (x))
2607 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2608 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
2610 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
2611 cfa.base_offset = offset;
2612 cfa.indirect = 1;
2613 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2614 break;
2618 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2620 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2622 if (!span)
2623 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
2624 else
2626 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
2627 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
2628 PARALLEL. */
2629 int par_index;
2630 int limit;
2631 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
2633 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
2635 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
2636 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2638 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
2640 queue_reg_save (label, elem, NULL_RTX, span_offset);
2641 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
2645 break;
2647 default:
2648 gcc_unreachable ();
2652 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
2653 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
2654 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
2656 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
2657 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
2659 void
2660 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
2662 const char *label;
2663 rtx note, n;
2664 bool handled_one = false;
2666 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
2668 size_t i;
2670 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
2671 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2673 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
2674 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
2675 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
2676 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
2678 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2679 cfa_store = cfa;
2680 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
2681 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
2683 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
2685 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
2686 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
2688 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
2690 if (barrier_args_size)
2692 XDELETEVEC (barrier_args_size);
2693 barrier_args_size = NULL;
2695 return;
2698 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2699 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2701 if (!RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
2703 /* ??? This should be done unconditionally since stack adjustments
2704 matter if the stack pointer is not the CFA register anymore but
2705 is still used to save registers. */
2706 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
2707 dwarf2out_notice_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
2708 return;
2711 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2713 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
2714 switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (note))
2716 case REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR:
2717 insn = XEXP (note, 0);
2718 goto found;
2720 case REG_CFA_DEF_CFA:
2721 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (XEXP (note, 0), label);
2722 handled_one = true;
2723 break;
2725 case REG_CFA_ADJUST_CFA:
2726 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2727 if (n == NULL)
2729 n = PATTERN (insn);
2730 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2731 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2733 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (n, label);
2734 handled_one = true;
2735 break;
2737 case REG_CFA_OFFSET:
2738 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2739 if (n == NULL)
2740 n = single_set (insn);
2741 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (n, label);
2742 handled_one = true;
2743 break;
2745 case REG_CFA_REGISTER:
2746 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2747 if (n == NULL)
2749 n = PATTERN (insn);
2750 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2751 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2753 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (n, label);
2754 handled_one = true;
2755 break;
2757 case REG_CFA_RESTORE:
2758 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2759 if (n == NULL)
2761 n = PATTERN (insn);
2762 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2763 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2764 n = XEXP (n, 0);
2766 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (n, label);
2767 handled_one = true;
2768 break;
2770 case REG_CFA_SET_VDRAP:
2771 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2772 if (REG_P (n))
2774 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
2775 if (fde)
2777 gcc_assert (fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM);
2778 if (REG_P (n))
2779 fde->vdrap_reg = REGNO (n);
2782 handled_one = true;
2783 break;
2785 default:
2786 break;
2788 if (handled_one)
2789 return;
2791 insn = PATTERN (insn);
2792 found:
2793 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
2796 /* Determine if we need to save and restore CFI information around this
2797 epilogue. If SIBCALL is true, then this is a sibcall epilogue. If
2798 we do need to save/restore, then emit the save now, and insert a
2799 NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE at the appropriate place in the stream. */
2801 void
2802 dwarf2out_cfi_begin_epilogue (rtx insn)
2804 bool saw_frp = false;
2805 rtx i;
2807 /* Scan forward to the return insn, noticing if there are possible
2808 frame related insns. */
2809 for (i = NEXT_INSN (insn); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
2811 if (!INSN_P (i))
2812 continue;
2814 /* Look for both regular and sibcalls to end the block. */
2815 if (returnjump_p (i))
2816 break;
2817 if (CALL_P (i) && SIBLING_CALL_P (i))
2818 break;
2820 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == SEQUENCE)
2822 int idx;
2823 rtx seq = PATTERN (i);
2825 if (returnjump_p (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2826 break;
2827 if (CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0))
2828 && SIBLING_CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2829 break;
2831 for (idx = 0; idx < XVECLEN (seq, 0); idx++)
2832 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, idx)))
2833 saw_frp = true;
2836 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (i))
2837 saw_frp = true;
2840 /* If the port doesn't emit epilogue unwind info, we don't need a
2841 save/restore pair. */
2842 if (!saw_frp)
2843 return;
2845 /* Otherwise, search forward to see if the return insn was the last
2846 basic block of the function. If so, we don't need save/restore. */
2847 gcc_assert (i != NULL);
2848 i = next_real_insn (i);
2849 if (i == NULL)
2850 return;
2852 /* Insert the restore before that next real insn in the stream, and before
2853 a potential NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG -- we do need these notes to be
2854 properly nested. This should be after any label or alignment. This
2855 will be pushed into the CFI stream by the function below. */
2856 while (1)
2858 rtx p = PREV_INSN (i);
2859 if (!NOTE_P (p))
2860 break;
2861 if (NOTE_KIND (p) == NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK)
2862 break;
2863 i = p;
2865 emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE, i);
2867 emit_cfa_remember = true;
2869 /* And emulate the state save. */
2870 gcc_assert (!cfa_remember.in_use);
2871 cfa_remember = cfa;
2872 cfa_remember.in_use = 1;
2875 /* A "subroutine" of dwarf2out_cfi_begin_epilogue. Emit the restore
2876 required. */
2878 void
2879 dwarf2out_frame_debug_restore_state (void)
2881 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2882 const char *label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2884 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_restore_state;
2885 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2887 gcc_assert (cfa_remember.in_use);
2888 cfa = cfa_remember;
2889 cfa_remember.in_use = 0;
2892 #endif
2894 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
2895 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
2896 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2898 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2899 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2901 switch (cfi)
2903 case DW_CFA_nop:
2904 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2905 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
2906 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
2907 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2909 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2910 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2911 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2912 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2913 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2914 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
2916 case DW_CFA_offset:
2917 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2918 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2919 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2920 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2921 case DW_CFA_restore:
2922 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2923 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2924 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2925 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2926 case DW_CFA_register:
2927 case DW_CFA_expression:
2928 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2930 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2931 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2932 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2933 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2935 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2936 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
2938 default:
2939 gcc_unreachable ();
2943 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
2944 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
2945 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2947 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2948 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2950 switch (cfi)
2952 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2953 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2954 case DW_CFA_offset:
2955 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2956 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2957 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2959 case DW_CFA_register:
2960 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2962 case DW_CFA_expression:
2963 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
2965 default:
2966 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2970 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2972 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
2973 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
2974 for collect2 the first time around. */
2976 static void
2977 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
2979 tree label;
2981 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2982 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
2984 int flags;
2986 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2988 int fde_encoding;
2989 int per_encoding;
2990 int lsda_encoding;
2992 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2993 /*global=*/0);
2994 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2995 /*global=*/1);
2996 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2997 /*global=*/0);
2998 flags = ((! flag_pic
2999 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3000 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
3001 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3002 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
3003 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3004 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
3005 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
3007 else
3008 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
3009 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
3011 #endif
3013 if (eh_frame_section)
3014 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
3015 else
3017 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
3018 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
3019 switch_to_section (data_section);
3021 if (!back)
3023 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
3024 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3025 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
3026 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3027 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3032 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
3033 FOR_EH. */
3035 static void
3036 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
3038 if (for_eh)
3039 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
3040 else
3042 if (!debug_frame_section)
3043 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
3044 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
3045 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
3049 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
3051 static void
3052 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
3054 unsigned long r;
3055 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
3057 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
3058 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
3059 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
3060 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
3061 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
3062 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset));
3063 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
3065 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3066 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3067 "DW_CFA_offset, column %#lx", r);
3068 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3069 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3071 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
3073 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3074 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3075 "DW_CFA_restore, column %#lx", r);
3077 else
3079 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
3080 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
3082 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3084 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3085 if (for_eh)
3086 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
3087 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
3088 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
3089 false, NULL);
3090 else
3091 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3092 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
3093 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3094 break;
3096 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3097 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3098 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3099 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3100 break;
3102 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3103 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3104 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3105 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3106 break;
3108 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3109 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3110 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3111 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3112 break;
3114 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3115 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3116 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3117 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3118 break;
3120 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3121 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3122 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3123 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3124 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3125 break;
3127 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3128 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3129 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3130 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3131 break;
3133 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3134 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3135 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3136 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3137 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3138 break;
3140 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3141 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3142 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3143 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3144 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3145 break;
3147 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3148 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3149 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3150 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3151 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3152 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3153 break;
3155 case DW_CFA_register:
3156 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3157 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3158 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3159 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3160 break;
3162 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3163 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3164 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3165 break;
3167 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3168 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3169 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3170 break;
3172 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3173 break;
3175 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3176 case DW_CFA_expression:
3177 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
3178 break;
3180 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3181 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
3182 gcc_unreachable ();
3184 default:
3185 break;
3190 /* Similar, but do it via assembler directives instead. */
3192 static void
3193 output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3195 unsigned long r, r2;
3197 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3199 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3200 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3201 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3202 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3203 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3204 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3205 /* Should only be created by add_fde_cfi in a code path not
3206 followed when emitting via directives. The assembler is
3207 going to take care of this for us. */
3208 gcc_unreachable ();
3210 case DW_CFA_offset:
3211 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3212 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3213 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3214 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_offset %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3215 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3216 break;
3218 case DW_CFA_restore:
3219 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3220 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3221 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore %lu\n", r);
3222 break;
3224 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3225 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3226 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_undefined %lu\n", r);
3227 break;
3229 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3230 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3231 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_same_value %lu\n", r);
3232 break;
3234 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3235 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3236 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3237 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3238 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3239 break;
3241 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3242 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3243 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_register %lu\n", r);
3244 break;
3246 case DW_CFA_register:
3247 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3248 r2 = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3249 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_register %lu, %lu\n", r, r2);
3250 break;
3252 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3253 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3254 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_offset "
3255 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3256 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3257 break;
3259 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3260 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_remember_state\n");
3261 break;
3262 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
3263 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore_state\n");
3264 break;
3266 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3267 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape %#x,", DW_CFA_GNU_args_size);
3268 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3269 if (flag_debug_asm)
3270 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s args_size "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
3271 ASM_COMMENT_START, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3272 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3273 break;
3275 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3276 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_window_save\n");
3277 break;
3279 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3280 case DW_CFA_expression:
3281 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape %#x,", cfi->dw_cfi_opc);
3282 output_cfa_loc_raw (cfi);
3283 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3284 break;
3286 default:
3287 gcc_unreachable ();
3291 DEF_VEC_P (dw_cfi_ref);
3292 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_cfi_ref, heap);
3294 /* Output CFIs to bring current FDE to the same state as after executing
3295 CFIs in CFI chain. DO_CFI_ASM is true if .cfi_* directives shall
3296 be emitted, false otherwise. If it is false, FDE and FOR_EH are the
3297 other arguments to pass to output_cfi. */
3299 static void
3300 output_cfis (dw_cfi_ref cfi, bool do_cfi_asm, dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh)
3302 struct dw_cfi_struct cfi_buf;
3303 dw_cfi_ref cfi2;
3304 dw_cfi_ref cfi_args_size = NULL, cfi_cfa = NULL, cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3305 VEC (dw_cfi_ref, heap) *regs = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, heap, 32);
3306 unsigned int len, idx;
3308 for (;; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3309 switch (cfi ? cfi->dw_cfi_opc : DW_CFA_nop)
3311 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3312 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3313 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3314 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3315 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3316 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3317 /* All advances should be ignored. */
3318 break;
3319 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3321 dw_cfi_ref args_size = cfi_args_size;
3323 /* Skip everything between .cfi_remember_state and
3324 .cfi_restore_state. */
3325 for (cfi2 = cfi->dw_cfi_next; cfi2; cfi2 = cfi2->dw_cfi_next)
3326 if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore_state)
3327 break;
3328 else if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_GNU_args_size)
3329 args_size = cfi2;
3330 else
3331 gcc_assert (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_remember_state);
3333 if (cfi2 == NULL)
3334 goto flush_all;
3335 else
3337 cfi = cfi2;
3338 cfi_args_size = args_size;
3340 break;
3342 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3343 cfi_args_size = cfi;
3344 break;
3345 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3346 goto flush_all;
3347 case DW_CFA_offset:
3348 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3349 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3350 case DW_CFA_restore:
3351 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3352 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3353 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3354 case DW_CFA_register:
3355 case DW_CFA_val_offset:
3356 case DW_CFA_val_offset_sf:
3357 case DW_CFA_expression:
3358 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
3359 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3360 if (VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs) <= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num)
3361 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs,
3362 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num + 1);
3363 VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, cfi);
3364 break;
3365 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3366 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3367 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3368 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3369 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3370 break;
3371 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3372 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3373 break;
3374 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3375 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3376 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3377 break;
3378 case DW_CFA_nop:
3379 gcc_assert (cfi == NULL);
3380 flush_all:
3381 len = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs);
3382 for (idx = 0; idx < len; idx++)
3384 cfi2 = VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, idx, NULL);
3385 if (cfi2 != NULL
3386 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore
3387 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore_extended)
3389 if (do_cfi_asm)
3390 output_cfi_directive (cfi2);
3391 else
3392 output_cfi (cfi2, fde, for_eh);
3395 if (cfi_cfa && cfi_cfa_offset && cfi_cfa_offset != cfi_cfa)
3397 gcc_assert (cfi_cfa->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression);
3398 cfi_buf = *cfi_cfa;
3399 switch (cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc)
3401 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3402 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
3403 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3404 break;
3405 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3406 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
3407 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3408 break;
3409 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3410 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3411 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc;
3412 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd2;
3413 break;
3414 default:
3415 gcc_unreachable ();
3417 cfi_cfa = &cfi_buf;
3419 else if (cfi_cfa_offset)
3420 cfi_cfa = cfi_cfa_offset;
3421 if (cfi_cfa)
3423 if (do_cfi_asm)
3424 output_cfi_directive (cfi_cfa);
3425 else
3426 output_cfi (cfi_cfa, fde, for_eh);
3428 cfi_cfa = NULL;
3429 cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3430 if (cfi_args_size
3431 && cfi_args_size->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset)
3433 if (do_cfi_asm)
3434 output_cfi_directive (cfi_args_size);
3435 else
3436 output_cfi (cfi_args_size, fde, for_eh);
3438 cfi_args_size = NULL;
3439 if (cfi == NULL)
3441 VEC_free (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs);
3442 return;
3444 else if (do_cfi_asm)
3445 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
3446 else
3447 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3448 break;
3449 default:
3450 gcc_unreachable ();
3454 /* Output one FDE. */
3456 static void
3457 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
3458 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
3459 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
3461 const char *begin, *end;
3462 static unsigned int j;
3463 char l1[20], l2[20];
3464 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3466 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
3467 /* empty */ 0);
3468 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
3469 for_eh + j);
3470 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3471 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3472 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3473 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
3474 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3475 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3476 "FDE Length");
3477 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3479 if (for_eh)
3480 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
3481 else
3482 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
3483 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
3485 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3487 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3488 end = fde->dw_fde_end;
3490 else
3492 /* For the first section, prefer dw_fde_begin over
3493 dw_fde_{hot,cold}_section_label, as the latter
3494 might be separated from the real start of the
3495 function by alignment padding. */
3496 if (!second)
3497 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3498 else if (fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3499 begin = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label;
3500 else
3501 begin = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
3502 if (second ^ fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3503 end = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
3504 else
3505 end = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
3508 if (for_eh)
3510 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
3511 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3512 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
3513 "FDE initial location");
3514 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
3515 end, begin, "FDE address range");
3517 else
3519 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
3520 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
3523 if (augmentation[0])
3525 if (any_lsda_needed)
3527 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
3529 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3531 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3532 + 4 /* CIE offset */
3533 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
3534 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
3535 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3537 size += pad;
3538 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
3541 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
3543 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3545 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3546 fde->funcdef_number);
3547 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
3548 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
3549 false,
3550 "Language Specific Data Area");
3552 else
3554 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3555 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3556 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
3557 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
3560 else
3561 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
3564 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
3565 this FDE. */
3566 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
3567 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3568 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3569 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3570 else if (!second)
3572 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3573 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3575 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3576 if (cfi == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3577 break;
3580 else
3582 dw_cfi_ref cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
3584 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3586 cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next;
3587 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
3588 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, false, fde, for_eh);
3589 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = cfi_next;
3591 for (cfi = cfi_next; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3592 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3595 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
3596 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
3597 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
3598 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
3599 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
3601 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
3602 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
3603 switch *back* into the table section. */
3604 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
3605 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
3606 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
3607 #endif
3609 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
3610 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3611 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
3612 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3614 j += 2;
3617 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
3619 static bool
3620 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
3622 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
3623 return true;
3625 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
3626 return true;
3628 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3629 return true;
3631 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
3632 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
3633 return false;
3635 return true;
3638 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
3639 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
3640 location of saved registers. */
3642 static void
3643 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
3645 unsigned int i;
3646 dw_fde_ref fde;
3647 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3648 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
3649 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
3650 char augmentation[6];
3651 int augmentation_size;
3652 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3653 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3654 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3655 int return_reg;
3656 rtx personality = NULL;
3657 int dw_cie_version;
3659 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
3660 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
3661 return;
3663 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
3664 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3665 return;
3667 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
3668 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
3669 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
3670 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
3671 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
3672 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
3673 if (for_eh)
3675 bool any_eh_needed = false;
3677 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3678 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
3679 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
3680 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (&fde_table[i]))
3681 any_eh_needed = true;
3682 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
3683 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
3684 1, 1);
3686 if (!any_eh_needed)
3687 return;
3690 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
3691 if (flag_debug_asm)
3692 app_enable ();
3694 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
3695 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
3697 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
3698 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
3700 /* Output the CIE. */
3701 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
3702 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
3703 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3704 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
3705 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3706 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3707 "Length of Common Information Entry");
3708 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3710 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
3711 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
3712 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
3713 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
3714 "CIE Identifier Tag");
3716 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
3717 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
3718 due to overflowing the return register column. */
3719 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
3720 dw_cie_version = 1;
3721 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
3722 dw_cie_version = 3;
3723 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
3725 augmentation[0] = 0;
3726 augmentation_size = 0;
3728 personality = current_unit_personality;
3729 if (for_eh)
3731 char *p;
3733 /* Augmentation:
3734 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
3735 augmentation section.
3736 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
3737 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
3738 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
3739 FDE code pointers.
3740 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
3741 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
3743 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
3744 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3745 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3747 p = augmentation + 1;
3748 if (personality)
3750 *p++ = 'P';
3751 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
3752 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
3754 if (any_lsda_needed)
3756 *p++ = 'L';
3757 augmentation_size += 1;
3759 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3761 *p++ = 'R';
3762 augmentation_size += 1;
3764 if (p > augmentation + 1)
3766 augmentation[0] = 'z';
3767 *p = '\0';
3770 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
3771 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3773 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3774 + 4 /* CIE Id */
3775 + 1 /* CIE version */
3776 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
3777 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
3778 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
3779 + 1 /* RA column */
3780 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
3781 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
3782 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3784 augmentation_size += pad;
3786 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
3787 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
3788 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
3792 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
3793 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
3795 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
3796 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
3798 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
3799 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
3800 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
3802 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
3803 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3804 else
3805 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3807 if (augmentation[0])
3809 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
3810 if (personality)
3812 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
3813 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
3814 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
3815 personality,
3816 true, NULL);
3819 if (any_lsda_needed)
3820 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
3821 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
3823 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3824 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
3825 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
3828 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3829 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
3831 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
3832 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3833 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
3834 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3836 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
3837 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3839 unsigned int k;
3840 fde = &fde_table[i];
3842 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
3843 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
3844 continue;
3846 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections ? 2 : 1); k++)
3847 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
3848 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
3851 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
3852 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
3853 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3854 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
3855 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
3856 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
3857 #endif
3859 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
3860 if (flag_debug_asm)
3861 app_disable ();
3864 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
3866 static void
3867 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
3869 int enc;
3870 rtx ref;
3871 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
3873 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
3875 if (personality)
3877 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3878 ref = personality;
3880 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
3881 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
3882 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
3883 of the weirder relocation types. */
3884 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3885 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3887 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
3888 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3889 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3892 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
3894 char lab[20];
3896 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3897 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3898 current_function_funcdef_no);
3899 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
3900 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3902 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3903 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3905 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
3906 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3907 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3911 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
3912 the prologue. */
3914 void
3915 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3916 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3918 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3919 char * dup_label;
3920 dw_fde_ref fde;
3921 section *fnsec;
3923 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
3925 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
3926 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
3927 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
3928 be used. */
3929 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
3930 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3931 return;
3932 #else
3933 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3934 return;
3935 #endif
3937 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
3938 switch_to_section (fnsec);
3939 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3940 current_function_funcdef_no);
3941 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3942 current_function_funcdef_no);
3943 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
3944 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
3946 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
3947 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
3948 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3949 return;
3950 #endif
3952 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
3953 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
3955 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
3956 fde_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_fde_node, fde_table, fde_table_allocated);
3957 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
3958 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
3961 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
3962 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
3964 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
3965 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
3966 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
3967 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
3968 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
3969 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
3970 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
3971 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
3972 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
3973 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 0;
3974 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = 0;
3975 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
3976 fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = NULL;
3977 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = NULL;
3978 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
3979 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = NULL;
3980 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
3981 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
3982 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
3983 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
3984 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
3985 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
3986 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
3988 section *unlikelysec;
3989 if (first_function_block_is_cold)
3990 fde->in_std_section = 1;
3991 else
3992 fde->in_std_section
3993 = (fnsec == text_section
3994 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
3995 unlikelysec = unlikely_text_section ();
3996 fde->cold_in_std_section
3997 = (unlikelysec == text_section
3998 || (cold_text_section && unlikelysec == cold_text_section));
4000 else
4002 fde->in_std_section
4003 = (fnsec == text_section
4004 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
4005 fde->cold_in_std_section = 0;
4008 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
4010 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
4011 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
4012 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4013 if (file)
4014 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
4015 #endif
4017 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4018 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
4019 else
4021 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
4022 if (!current_unit_personality)
4023 current_unit_personality = personality;
4025 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
4026 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
4027 function anymore. */
4028 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
4029 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
4030 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
4034 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
4035 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
4036 been generated. */
4038 void
4039 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4040 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4042 dw_fde_ref fde;
4043 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4045 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4046 function. */
4047 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
4048 current_function_funcdef_no);
4049 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
4050 current_function_funcdef_no);
4051 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
4052 fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
4055 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
4056 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
4057 been generated. */
4059 void
4060 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4061 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4063 dw_fde_ref fde;
4064 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4066 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
4067 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
4068 return;
4070 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4071 function. */
4072 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
4073 current_function_funcdef_no);
4074 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
4075 current_function_funcdef_no);
4076 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
4079 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
4080 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
4081 been generated. */
4083 void
4084 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4085 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4087 dw_fde_ref fde;
4088 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4090 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4091 last_var_location_insn = NULL_RTX;
4092 #endif
4094 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4095 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4097 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4098 function. */
4099 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
4100 current_function_funcdef_no);
4101 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
4102 fde = current_fde ();
4103 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
4104 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
4107 void
4108 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
4110 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
4111 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_fde_node (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
4112 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4113 fde_table_in_use = 0;
4115 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
4116 sake of lookup_cfa. */
4118 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
4119 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
4121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
4122 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
4123 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
4124 #endif
4127 void
4128 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
4130 /* Output call frame information. */
4131 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
4132 output_call_frame_info (0);
4134 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
4135 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
4136 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
4137 output_call_frame_info (1);
4138 #endif
4141 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
4143 static void
4144 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
4146 section *sec = current_function_section ();
4147 if (sec == text_section)
4148 text_section_used = true;
4149 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
4150 cold_text_section_used = true;
4153 void
4154 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
4156 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
4158 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && !fde->dw_fde_switched_sections);
4160 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 1;
4161 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = !in_cold_section_p;
4163 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
4164 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
4165 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
4166 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
4167 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
4169 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
4170 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
4171 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
4173 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
4174 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
4175 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
4177 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4178 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4180 /* Now do the real section switch. */
4181 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
4183 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4185 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
4186 /* As this is a different FDE, insert all current CFI instructions
4187 again. */
4188 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, true, fde, true);
4190 else
4192 dw_cfi_ref cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4194 cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4195 if (cfi)
4196 while (cfi->dw_cfi_next != NULL)
4197 cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next;
4198 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = cfi;
4201 #endif
4203 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
4204 for emitting location expressions. */
4206 /* Data about a single source file. */
4207 struct GTY(()) dwarf_file_data {
4208 const char * filename;
4209 int emitted_number;
4212 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
4213 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
4214 typedef const struct die_struct *const_dw_die_ref;
4215 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
4216 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
4218 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
4220 tree variable;
4221 dw_die_ref die;
4222 } deferred_locations;
4224 DEF_VEC_O(deferred_locations);
4225 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(deferred_locations,gc);
4227 static GTY(()) VEC(deferred_locations, gc) *deferred_locations_list;
4229 DEF_VEC_P(dw_die_ref);
4230 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_die_ref,heap);
4232 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
4233 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
4234 implementation are listed below. */
4236 enum dw_val_class
4238 dw_val_class_addr,
4239 dw_val_class_offset,
4240 dw_val_class_loc,
4241 dw_val_class_loc_list,
4242 dw_val_class_range_list,
4243 dw_val_class_const,
4244 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
4245 dw_val_class_const_double,
4246 dw_val_class_vec,
4247 dw_val_class_flag,
4248 dw_val_class_die_ref,
4249 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
4250 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
4251 dw_val_class_lineptr,
4252 dw_val_class_str,
4253 dw_val_class_macptr,
4254 dw_val_class_file,
4255 dw_val_class_data8,
4256 dw_val_class_vms_delta
4259 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
4261 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_vec_struct {
4262 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
4263 unsigned length;
4264 unsigned elt_size;
4266 dw_vec_const;
4268 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
4269 represented internally. */
4271 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_val_struct {
4272 enum dw_val_class val_class;
4273 union dw_val_struct_union
4275 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
4276 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
4277 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
4278 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
4279 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
4280 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
4281 double_int GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_const_double"))) val_double;
4282 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
4283 struct dw_val_die_union
4285 dw_die_ref die;
4286 int external;
4287 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
4288 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
4289 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
4290 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
4291 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
4292 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
4293 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_data8"))) val_data8[8];
4294 struct dw_val_vms_delta_union
4296 char * lbl1;
4297 char * lbl2;
4298 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vms_delta"))) val_vms_delta;
4300 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
4302 dw_val_node;
4304 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
4305 operations. */
4307 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_descr_struct {
4308 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
4309 ENUM_BITFIELD (dwarf_location_atom) dw_loc_opc : 8;
4310 /* Used to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol relocation
4311 from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
4312 unsigned int dtprel : 1;
4313 int dw_loc_addr;
4314 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
4315 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
4317 dw_loc_descr_node;
4319 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
4320 so you can track variables that are in different places over
4321 their entire life. */
4322 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
4323 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
4324 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
4325 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
4326 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
4327 Only on head of list */
4328 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
4329 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
4330 } dw_loc_list_node;
4332 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
4334 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4336 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
4338 static const char *
4339 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
4341 switch (op)
4343 case DW_OP_addr:
4344 return "DW_OP_addr";
4345 case DW_OP_deref:
4346 return "DW_OP_deref";
4347 case DW_OP_const1u:
4348 return "DW_OP_const1u";
4349 case DW_OP_const1s:
4350 return "DW_OP_const1s";
4351 case DW_OP_const2u:
4352 return "DW_OP_const2u";
4353 case DW_OP_const2s:
4354 return "DW_OP_const2s";
4355 case DW_OP_const4u:
4356 return "DW_OP_const4u";
4357 case DW_OP_const4s:
4358 return "DW_OP_const4s";
4359 case DW_OP_const8u:
4360 return "DW_OP_const8u";
4361 case DW_OP_const8s:
4362 return "DW_OP_const8s";
4363 case DW_OP_constu:
4364 return "DW_OP_constu";
4365 case DW_OP_consts:
4366 return "DW_OP_consts";
4367 case DW_OP_dup:
4368 return "DW_OP_dup";
4369 case DW_OP_drop:
4370 return "DW_OP_drop";
4371 case DW_OP_over:
4372 return "DW_OP_over";
4373 case DW_OP_pick:
4374 return "DW_OP_pick";
4375 case DW_OP_swap:
4376 return "DW_OP_swap";
4377 case DW_OP_rot:
4378 return "DW_OP_rot";
4379 case DW_OP_xderef:
4380 return "DW_OP_xderef";
4381 case DW_OP_abs:
4382 return "DW_OP_abs";
4383 case DW_OP_and:
4384 return "DW_OP_and";
4385 case DW_OP_div:
4386 return "DW_OP_div";
4387 case DW_OP_minus:
4388 return "DW_OP_minus";
4389 case DW_OP_mod:
4390 return "DW_OP_mod";
4391 case DW_OP_mul:
4392 return "DW_OP_mul";
4393 case DW_OP_neg:
4394 return "DW_OP_neg";
4395 case DW_OP_not:
4396 return "DW_OP_not";
4397 case DW_OP_or:
4398 return "DW_OP_or";
4399 case DW_OP_plus:
4400 return "DW_OP_plus";
4401 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4402 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
4403 case DW_OP_shl:
4404 return "DW_OP_shl";
4405 case DW_OP_shr:
4406 return "DW_OP_shr";
4407 case DW_OP_shra:
4408 return "DW_OP_shra";
4409 case DW_OP_xor:
4410 return "DW_OP_xor";
4411 case DW_OP_bra:
4412 return "DW_OP_bra";
4413 case DW_OP_eq:
4414 return "DW_OP_eq";
4415 case DW_OP_ge:
4416 return "DW_OP_ge";
4417 case DW_OP_gt:
4418 return "DW_OP_gt";
4419 case DW_OP_le:
4420 return "DW_OP_le";
4421 case DW_OP_lt:
4422 return "DW_OP_lt";
4423 case DW_OP_ne:
4424 return "DW_OP_ne";
4425 case DW_OP_skip:
4426 return "DW_OP_skip";
4427 case DW_OP_lit0:
4428 return "DW_OP_lit0";
4429 case DW_OP_lit1:
4430 return "DW_OP_lit1";
4431 case DW_OP_lit2:
4432 return "DW_OP_lit2";
4433 case DW_OP_lit3:
4434 return "DW_OP_lit3";
4435 case DW_OP_lit4:
4436 return "DW_OP_lit4";
4437 case DW_OP_lit5:
4438 return "DW_OP_lit5";
4439 case DW_OP_lit6:
4440 return "DW_OP_lit6";
4441 case DW_OP_lit7:
4442 return "DW_OP_lit7";
4443 case DW_OP_lit8:
4444 return "DW_OP_lit8";
4445 case DW_OP_lit9:
4446 return "DW_OP_lit9";
4447 case DW_OP_lit10:
4448 return "DW_OP_lit10";
4449 case DW_OP_lit11:
4450 return "DW_OP_lit11";
4451 case DW_OP_lit12:
4452 return "DW_OP_lit12";
4453 case DW_OP_lit13:
4454 return "DW_OP_lit13";
4455 case DW_OP_lit14:
4456 return "DW_OP_lit14";
4457 case DW_OP_lit15:
4458 return "DW_OP_lit15";
4459 case DW_OP_lit16:
4460 return "DW_OP_lit16";
4461 case DW_OP_lit17:
4462 return "DW_OP_lit17";
4463 case DW_OP_lit18:
4464 return "DW_OP_lit18";
4465 case DW_OP_lit19:
4466 return "DW_OP_lit19";
4467 case DW_OP_lit20:
4468 return "DW_OP_lit20";
4469 case DW_OP_lit21:
4470 return "DW_OP_lit21";
4471 case DW_OP_lit22:
4472 return "DW_OP_lit22";
4473 case DW_OP_lit23:
4474 return "DW_OP_lit23";
4475 case DW_OP_lit24:
4476 return "DW_OP_lit24";
4477 case DW_OP_lit25:
4478 return "DW_OP_lit25";
4479 case DW_OP_lit26:
4480 return "DW_OP_lit26";
4481 case DW_OP_lit27:
4482 return "DW_OP_lit27";
4483 case DW_OP_lit28:
4484 return "DW_OP_lit28";
4485 case DW_OP_lit29:
4486 return "DW_OP_lit29";
4487 case DW_OP_lit30:
4488 return "DW_OP_lit30";
4489 case DW_OP_lit31:
4490 return "DW_OP_lit31";
4491 case DW_OP_reg0:
4492 return "DW_OP_reg0";
4493 case DW_OP_reg1:
4494 return "DW_OP_reg1";
4495 case DW_OP_reg2:
4496 return "DW_OP_reg2";
4497 case DW_OP_reg3:
4498 return "DW_OP_reg3";
4499 case DW_OP_reg4:
4500 return "DW_OP_reg4";
4501 case DW_OP_reg5:
4502 return "DW_OP_reg5";
4503 case DW_OP_reg6:
4504 return "DW_OP_reg6";
4505 case DW_OP_reg7:
4506 return "DW_OP_reg7";
4507 case DW_OP_reg8:
4508 return "DW_OP_reg8";
4509 case DW_OP_reg9:
4510 return "DW_OP_reg9";
4511 case DW_OP_reg10:
4512 return "DW_OP_reg10";
4513 case DW_OP_reg11:
4514 return "DW_OP_reg11";
4515 case DW_OP_reg12:
4516 return "DW_OP_reg12";
4517 case DW_OP_reg13:
4518 return "DW_OP_reg13";
4519 case DW_OP_reg14:
4520 return "DW_OP_reg14";
4521 case DW_OP_reg15:
4522 return "DW_OP_reg15";
4523 case DW_OP_reg16:
4524 return "DW_OP_reg16";
4525 case DW_OP_reg17:
4526 return "DW_OP_reg17";
4527 case DW_OP_reg18:
4528 return "DW_OP_reg18";
4529 case DW_OP_reg19:
4530 return "DW_OP_reg19";
4531 case DW_OP_reg20:
4532 return "DW_OP_reg20";
4533 case DW_OP_reg21:
4534 return "DW_OP_reg21";
4535 case DW_OP_reg22:
4536 return "DW_OP_reg22";
4537 case DW_OP_reg23:
4538 return "DW_OP_reg23";
4539 case DW_OP_reg24:
4540 return "DW_OP_reg24";
4541 case DW_OP_reg25:
4542 return "DW_OP_reg25";
4543 case DW_OP_reg26:
4544 return "DW_OP_reg26";
4545 case DW_OP_reg27:
4546 return "DW_OP_reg27";
4547 case DW_OP_reg28:
4548 return "DW_OP_reg28";
4549 case DW_OP_reg29:
4550 return "DW_OP_reg29";
4551 case DW_OP_reg30:
4552 return "DW_OP_reg30";
4553 case DW_OP_reg31:
4554 return "DW_OP_reg31";
4555 case DW_OP_breg0:
4556 return "DW_OP_breg0";
4557 case DW_OP_breg1:
4558 return "DW_OP_breg1";
4559 case DW_OP_breg2:
4560 return "DW_OP_breg2";
4561 case DW_OP_breg3:
4562 return "DW_OP_breg3";
4563 case DW_OP_breg4:
4564 return "DW_OP_breg4";
4565 case DW_OP_breg5:
4566 return "DW_OP_breg5";
4567 case DW_OP_breg6:
4568 return "DW_OP_breg6";
4569 case DW_OP_breg7:
4570 return "DW_OP_breg7";
4571 case DW_OP_breg8:
4572 return "DW_OP_breg8";
4573 case DW_OP_breg9:
4574 return "DW_OP_breg9";
4575 case DW_OP_breg10:
4576 return "DW_OP_breg10";
4577 case DW_OP_breg11:
4578 return "DW_OP_breg11";
4579 case DW_OP_breg12:
4580 return "DW_OP_breg12";
4581 case DW_OP_breg13:
4582 return "DW_OP_breg13";
4583 case DW_OP_breg14:
4584 return "DW_OP_breg14";
4585 case DW_OP_breg15:
4586 return "DW_OP_breg15";
4587 case DW_OP_breg16:
4588 return "DW_OP_breg16";
4589 case DW_OP_breg17:
4590 return "DW_OP_breg17";
4591 case DW_OP_breg18:
4592 return "DW_OP_breg18";
4593 case DW_OP_breg19:
4594 return "DW_OP_breg19";
4595 case DW_OP_breg20:
4596 return "DW_OP_breg20";
4597 case DW_OP_breg21:
4598 return "DW_OP_breg21";
4599 case DW_OP_breg22:
4600 return "DW_OP_breg22";
4601 case DW_OP_breg23:
4602 return "DW_OP_breg23";
4603 case DW_OP_breg24:
4604 return "DW_OP_breg24";
4605 case DW_OP_breg25:
4606 return "DW_OP_breg25";
4607 case DW_OP_breg26:
4608 return "DW_OP_breg26";
4609 case DW_OP_breg27:
4610 return "DW_OP_breg27";
4611 case DW_OP_breg28:
4612 return "DW_OP_breg28";
4613 case DW_OP_breg29:
4614 return "DW_OP_breg29";
4615 case DW_OP_breg30:
4616 return "DW_OP_breg30";
4617 case DW_OP_breg31:
4618 return "DW_OP_breg31";
4619 case DW_OP_regx:
4620 return "DW_OP_regx";
4621 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4622 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
4623 case DW_OP_bregx:
4624 return "DW_OP_bregx";
4625 case DW_OP_piece:
4626 return "DW_OP_piece";
4627 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4628 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
4629 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4630 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
4631 case DW_OP_nop:
4632 return "DW_OP_nop";
4634 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
4635 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
4636 case DW_OP_call2:
4637 return "DW_OP_call2";
4638 case DW_OP_call4:
4639 return "DW_OP_call4";
4640 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4641 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
4642 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4643 return "DW_OP_implicit_value";
4644 case DW_OP_stack_value:
4645 return "DW_OP_stack_value";
4646 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
4647 return "DW_OP_form_tls_address";
4648 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
4649 return "DW_OP_call_frame_cfa";
4650 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4651 return "DW_OP_bit_piece";
4653 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
4654 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
4655 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
4656 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
4657 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
4658 return "DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr";
4660 default:
4661 return "OP_<unknown>";
4665 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
4666 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
4667 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
4669 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4670 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
4671 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
4673 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_descr_node ();
4675 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
4676 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4677 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
4678 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4679 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
4681 return descr;
4684 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
4685 REG and OFFSET. */
4687 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4688 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4690 if (reg <= 31)
4691 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
4692 offset, 0);
4693 else
4694 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
4697 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
4699 static inline void
4700 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4702 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
4704 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4705 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
4708 *d = descr;
4711 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
4713 static void
4714 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4716 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4717 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
4719 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
4721 if (!offset)
4722 return;
4724 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4725 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
4728 p = NULL;
4729 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
4730 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
4731 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
4732 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
4733 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
4735 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
4736 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
4737 if (p != NULL
4738 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
4739 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
4740 *p += offset;
4742 else if (offset > 0)
4743 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
4745 else
4747 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
4748 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
4752 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4753 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
4755 static void
4756 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4758 dw_loc_list_ref d;
4759 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
4760 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
4762 #endif
4764 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
4766 static unsigned long
4767 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4769 unsigned long size = 1;
4771 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4773 case DW_OP_addr:
4774 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4775 break;
4776 case DW_OP_const1u:
4777 case DW_OP_const1s:
4778 size += 1;
4779 break;
4780 case DW_OP_const2u:
4781 case DW_OP_const2s:
4782 size += 2;
4783 break;
4784 case DW_OP_const4u:
4785 case DW_OP_const4s:
4786 size += 4;
4787 break;
4788 case DW_OP_const8u:
4789 case DW_OP_const8s:
4790 size += 8;
4791 break;
4792 case DW_OP_constu:
4793 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4794 break;
4795 case DW_OP_consts:
4796 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4797 break;
4798 case DW_OP_pick:
4799 size += 1;
4800 break;
4801 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4802 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4803 break;
4804 case DW_OP_skip:
4805 case DW_OP_bra:
4806 size += 2;
4807 break;
4808 case DW_OP_breg0:
4809 case DW_OP_breg1:
4810 case DW_OP_breg2:
4811 case DW_OP_breg3:
4812 case DW_OP_breg4:
4813 case DW_OP_breg5:
4814 case DW_OP_breg6:
4815 case DW_OP_breg7:
4816 case DW_OP_breg8:
4817 case DW_OP_breg9:
4818 case DW_OP_breg10:
4819 case DW_OP_breg11:
4820 case DW_OP_breg12:
4821 case DW_OP_breg13:
4822 case DW_OP_breg14:
4823 case DW_OP_breg15:
4824 case DW_OP_breg16:
4825 case DW_OP_breg17:
4826 case DW_OP_breg18:
4827 case DW_OP_breg19:
4828 case DW_OP_breg20:
4829 case DW_OP_breg21:
4830 case DW_OP_breg22:
4831 case DW_OP_breg23:
4832 case DW_OP_breg24:
4833 case DW_OP_breg25:
4834 case DW_OP_breg26:
4835 case DW_OP_breg27:
4836 case DW_OP_breg28:
4837 case DW_OP_breg29:
4838 case DW_OP_breg30:
4839 case DW_OP_breg31:
4840 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4841 break;
4842 case DW_OP_regx:
4843 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4844 break;
4845 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4846 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4847 break;
4848 case DW_OP_bregx:
4849 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4850 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
4851 break;
4852 case DW_OP_piece:
4853 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4854 break;
4855 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4856 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4857 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
4858 break;
4859 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4860 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4861 size += 1;
4862 break;
4863 case DW_OP_call2:
4864 size += 2;
4865 break;
4866 case DW_OP_call4:
4867 size += 4;
4868 break;
4869 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4870 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4871 break;
4872 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4873 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
4874 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
4875 break;
4876 default:
4877 break;
4880 return size;
4883 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
4885 static unsigned long
4886 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4888 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
4889 unsigned long size;
4891 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
4892 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
4893 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4895 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
4896 break;
4897 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4899 if (! l)
4900 return size;
4902 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4904 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
4905 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4908 return size;
4911 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4912 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4913 #endif
4915 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
4917 static void
4918 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4920 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
4921 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
4923 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4925 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4926 case DW_OP_const2u:
4927 case DW_OP_const2s:
4928 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4929 break;
4930 case DW_OP_const4u:
4931 if (loc->dtprel)
4933 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
4934 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
4935 val1->v.val_addr);
4936 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
4937 break;
4939 /* FALLTHRU */
4940 case DW_OP_const4s:
4941 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4942 break;
4943 case DW_OP_const8u:
4944 if (loc->dtprel)
4946 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
4947 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
4948 val1->v.val_addr);
4949 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
4950 break;
4952 /* FALLTHRU */
4953 case DW_OP_const8s:
4954 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
4955 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4956 break;
4957 case DW_OP_skip:
4958 case DW_OP_bra:
4960 int offset;
4962 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
4963 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
4965 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
4967 break;
4968 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4969 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4970 switch (val2->val_class)
4972 case dw_val_class_const:
4973 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
4974 break;
4975 case dw_val_class_vec:
4977 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
4978 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
4979 unsigned int i;
4980 unsigned char *p;
4982 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
4984 elt_size /= 2;
4985 len *= 2;
4987 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
4988 i < len;
4989 i++, p += elt_size)
4990 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
4991 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
4993 break;
4994 case dw_val_class_const_double:
4996 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
4998 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
5000 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
5001 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
5003 else
5005 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
5006 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
5008 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
5009 first, NULL);
5010 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
5011 second, NULL);
5013 break;
5014 case dw_val_class_addr:
5015 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
5016 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
5017 break;
5018 default:
5019 gcc_unreachable ();
5021 break;
5022 #else
5023 case DW_OP_const2u:
5024 case DW_OP_const2s:
5025 case DW_OP_const4u:
5026 case DW_OP_const4s:
5027 case DW_OP_const8u:
5028 case DW_OP_const8s:
5029 case DW_OP_skip:
5030 case DW_OP_bra:
5031 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5032 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
5033 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
5034 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
5035 only doing unwinding. */
5036 gcc_unreachable ();
5037 #endif
5038 case DW_OP_const1u:
5039 case DW_OP_const1s:
5040 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5041 break;
5042 case DW_OP_constu:
5043 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5044 break;
5045 case DW_OP_consts:
5046 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5047 break;
5048 case DW_OP_pick:
5049 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5050 break;
5051 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5052 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5053 break;
5054 case DW_OP_breg0:
5055 case DW_OP_breg1:
5056 case DW_OP_breg2:
5057 case DW_OP_breg3:
5058 case DW_OP_breg4:
5059 case DW_OP_breg5:
5060 case DW_OP_breg6:
5061 case DW_OP_breg7:
5062 case DW_OP_breg8:
5063 case DW_OP_breg9:
5064 case DW_OP_breg10:
5065 case DW_OP_breg11:
5066 case DW_OP_breg12:
5067 case DW_OP_breg13:
5068 case DW_OP_breg14:
5069 case DW_OP_breg15:
5070 case DW_OP_breg16:
5071 case DW_OP_breg17:
5072 case DW_OP_breg18:
5073 case DW_OP_breg19:
5074 case DW_OP_breg20:
5075 case DW_OP_breg21:
5076 case DW_OP_breg22:
5077 case DW_OP_breg23:
5078 case DW_OP_breg24:
5079 case DW_OP_breg25:
5080 case DW_OP_breg26:
5081 case DW_OP_breg27:
5082 case DW_OP_breg28:
5083 case DW_OP_breg29:
5084 case DW_OP_breg30:
5085 case DW_OP_breg31:
5086 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5087 break;
5088 case DW_OP_regx:
5089 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5090 break;
5091 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5092 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5093 break;
5094 case DW_OP_bregx:
5095 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5096 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5097 break;
5098 case DW_OP_piece:
5099 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5100 break;
5101 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5102 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5103 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5104 break;
5105 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5106 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5107 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5108 break;
5110 case DW_OP_addr:
5111 if (loc->dtprel)
5113 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
5115 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
5116 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
5117 val1->v.val_addr);
5118 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5120 else
5121 gcc_unreachable ();
5123 else
5125 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5126 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
5127 #else
5128 gcc_unreachable ();
5129 #endif
5131 break;
5133 default:
5134 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5135 break;
5139 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
5141 static void
5142 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5144 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5146 /* Output the opcode. */
5147 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
5148 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
5150 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
5151 output_loc_operands (loc);
5155 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
5156 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
5158 static void
5159 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5161 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
5162 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
5164 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
5166 case DW_OP_addr:
5167 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5168 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
5169 gcc_unreachable ();
5171 case DW_OP_const1u:
5172 case DW_OP_const1s:
5173 case DW_OP_pick:
5174 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5175 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5176 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5177 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
5178 break;
5180 case DW_OP_const2u:
5181 case DW_OP_const2s:
5182 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5183 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
5184 break;
5186 case DW_OP_const4u:
5187 case DW_OP_const4s:
5188 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5189 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
5190 break;
5192 case DW_OP_const8u:
5193 case DW_OP_const8s:
5194 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5195 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5196 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
5197 break;
5199 case DW_OP_skip:
5200 case DW_OP_bra:
5202 int offset;
5204 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5205 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5207 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5208 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
5210 break;
5212 case DW_OP_constu:
5213 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5214 case DW_OP_regx:
5215 case DW_OP_piece:
5216 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5217 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5218 break;
5220 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5221 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5222 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5223 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
5224 break;
5226 case DW_OP_consts:
5227 case DW_OP_breg0:
5228 case DW_OP_breg1:
5229 case DW_OP_breg2:
5230 case DW_OP_breg3:
5231 case DW_OP_breg4:
5232 case DW_OP_breg5:
5233 case DW_OP_breg6:
5234 case DW_OP_breg7:
5235 case DW_OP_breg8:
5236 case DW_OP_breg9:
5237 case DW_OP_breg10:
5238 case DW_OP_breg11:
5239 case DW_OP_breg12:
5240 case DW_OP_breg13:
5241 case DW_OP_breg14:
5242 case DW_OP_breg15:
5243 case DW_OP_breg16:
5244 case DW_OP_breg17:
5245 case DW_OP_breg18:
5246 case DW_OP_breg19:
5247 case DW_OP_breg20:
5248 case DW_OP_breg21:
5249 case DW_OP_breg22:
5250 case DW_OP_breg23:
5251 case DW_OP_breg24:
5252 case DW_OP_breg25:
5253 case DW_OP_breg26:
5254 case DW_OP_breg27:
5255 case DW_OP_breg28:
5256 case DW_OP_breg29:
5257 case DW_OP_breg30:
5258 case DW_OP_breg31:
5259 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5260 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5261 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
5262 break;
5264 case DW_OP_bregx:
5265 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5266 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5267 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5268 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
5269 break;
5271 default:
5272 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5273 break;
5277 static void
5278 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5280 while (1)
5282 /* Output the opcode. */
5283 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", loc->dw_loc_opc);
5284 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
5286 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
5287 break;
5288 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5290 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5294 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
5295 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
5297 static void
5298 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5300 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5301 unsigned long size;
5303 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5305 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, NULL);
5306 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc;
5308 else
5309 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5311 /* Output the size of the block. */
5312 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5313 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
5315 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5316 output_loc_sequence (loc);
5319 /* Similar, but used for .cfi_escape. */
5321 static void
5322 output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5324 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5325 unsigned long size;
5327 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5329 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x,", cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
5330 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc;
5332 else
5333 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5335 /* Output the size of the block. */
5336 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5337 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (size);
5338 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5340 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5341 output_loc_sequence_raw (loc);
5344 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
5345 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
5346 expression. */
5348 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5349 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5351 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
5353 offset += cfa->offset;
5355 if (cfa->indirect)
5357 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
5358 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
5359 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
5360 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5361 if (offset != 0)
5363 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
5364 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5367 else
5368 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
5370 return head;
5373 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
5374 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
5375 ALIGNMENT byte. */
5377 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5378 build_cfa_aligned_loc (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
5380 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head;
5381 unsigned int dwarf_fp
5382 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
5384 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
5385 if (cfa.reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa.indirect == 0)
5387 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
5388 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
5389 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
5390 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
5392 else
5393 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
5394 return head;
5397 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
5398 descriptor sequence. */
5400 static void
5401 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
5403 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
5404 cfa->offset = 0;
5405 cfa->base_offset = 0;
5406 cfa->indirect = 0;
5407 cfa->reg = -1;
5409 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
5411 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
5413 switch (op)
5415 case DW_OP_reg0:
5416 case DW_OP_reg1:
5417 case DW_OP_reg2:
5418 case DW_OP_reg3:
5419 case DW_OP_reg4:
5420 case DW_OP_reg5:
5421 case DW_OP_reg6:
5422 case DW_OP_reg7:
5423 case DW_OP_reg8:
5424 case DW_OP_reg9:
5425 case DW_OP_reg10:
5426 case DW_OP_reg11:
5427 case DW_OP_reg12:
5428 case DW_OP_reg13:
5429 case DW_OP_reg14:
5430 case DW_OP_reg15:
5431 case DW_OP_reg16:
5432 case DW_OP_reg17:
5433 case DW_OP_reg18:
5434 case DW_OP_reg19:
5435 case DW_OP_reg20:
5436 case DW_OP_reg21:
5437 case DW_OP_reg22:
5438 case DW_OP_reg23:
5439 case DW_OP_reg24:
5440 case DW_OP_reg25:
5441 case DW_OP_reg26:
5442 case DW_OP_reg27:
5443 case DW_OP_reg28:
5444 case DW_OP_reg29:
5445 case DW_OP_reg30:
5446 case DW_OP_reg31:
5447 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
5448 break;
5449 case DW_OP_regx:
5450 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5451 break;
5452 case DW_OP_breg0:
5453 case DW_OP_breg1:
5454 case DW_OP_breg2:
5455 case DW_OP_breg3:
5456 case DW_OP_breg4:
5457 case DW_OP_breg5:
5458 case DW_OP_breg6:
5459 case DW_OP_breg7:
5460 case DW_OP_breg8:
5461 case DW_OP_breg9:
5462 case DW_OP_breg10:
5463 case DW_OP_breg11:
5464 case DW_OP_breg12:
5465 case DW_OP_breg13:
5466 case DW_OP_breg14:
5467 case DW_OP_breg15:
5468 case DW_OP_breg16:
5469 case DW_OP_breg17:
5470 case DW_OP_breg18:
5471 case DW_OP_breg19:
5472 case DW_OP_breg20:
5473 case DW_OP_breg21:
5474 case DW_OP_breg22:
5475 case DW_OP_breg23:
5476 case DW_OP_breg24:
5477 case DW_OP_breg25:
5478 case DW_OP_breg26:
5479 case DW_OP_breg27:
5480 case DW_OP_breg28:
5481 case DW_OP_breg29:
5482 case DW_OP_breg30:
5483 case DW_OP_breg31:
5484 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
5485 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5486 break;
5487 case DW_OP_bregx:
5488 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5489 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
5490 break;
5491 case DW_OP_deref:
5492 cfa->indirect = 1;
5493 break;
5494 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5495 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
5496 break;
5497 default:
5498 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
5499 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
5503 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
5505 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
5506 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5508 /* .debug_str support. */
5509 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
5511 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
5512 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
5513 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
5514 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
5515 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
5516 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
5517 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
5518 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
5519 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5520 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5521 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
5522 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
5523 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
5524 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
5525 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
5526 dw_die_ref);
5527 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
5528 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
5529 static void dwarf2out_direct_call (tree);
5530 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree, int);
5531 static void dwarf2out_copy_call_info (rtx, rtx);
5532 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call (int);
5533 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
5534 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
5536 /* The debug hooks structure. */
5538 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
5540 dwarf2out_init,
5541 dwarf2out_finish,
5542 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
5543 dwarf2out_define,
5544 dwarf2out_undef,
5545 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
5546 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
5547 dwarf2out_begin_block,
5548 dwarf2out_end_block,
5549 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
5550 dwarf2out_source_line,
5551 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
5552 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5553 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
5554 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
5555 #else
5556 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
5557 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
5558 #endif
5559 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
5560 dwarf2out_begin_function,
5561 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
5562 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
5563 dwarf2out_global_decl,
5564 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
5565 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
5566 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
5567 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
5568 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
5569 something tries to reference them. */
5570 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
5571 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
5572 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
5573 dwarf2out_var_location,
5574 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
5575 dwarf2out_direct_call,
5576 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token,
5577 dwarf2out_copy_call_info,
5578 dwarf2out_virtual_call,
5579 dwarf2out_set_name,
5580 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
5582 #endif
5584 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
5585 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
5586 throughout the remainder of this file. */
5588 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
5589 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
5590 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
5591 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
5593 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
5594 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
5596 typedef long int dw_offset;
5598 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
5600 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
5601 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
5602 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
5603 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
5604 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
5605 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
5606 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
5608 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
5609 line number associated with the label generated for that
5610 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
5611 the line number entry. */
5613 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
5614 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5615 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5617 dw_line_info_entry;
5619 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
5620 own sequence. */
5621 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_separate_line_info_struct {
5622 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5623 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5624 unsigned long function;
5626 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
5628 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
5629 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
5630 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
5632 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
5633 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
5634 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
5636 dw_attr_node;
5638 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
5639 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
5641 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
5642 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
5643 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
5645 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"))) die_struct {
5646 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
5647 union die_symbol_or_type_node
5649 char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
5650 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
5652 GTY ((desc ("dwarf_version >= 4"))) die_id;
5653 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
5654 dw_die_ref die_parent;
5655 dw_die_ref die_child;
5656 dw_die_ref die_sib;
5657 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
5658 dw_offset die_offset;
5659 unsigned long die_abbrev;
5660 int die_mark;
5661 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
5662 int die_perennial_p;
5663 unsigned int decl_id;
5665 die_node;
5667 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
5668 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
5669 c = die->die_child; \
5670 if (c) do { \
5671 c = c->die_sib; \
5672 expr; \
5673 } while (c != die->die_child); \
5674 } while (0)
5676 /* The pubname structure */
5678 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
5679 dw_die_ref die;
5680 const char *name;
5682 pubname_entry;
5684 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
5685 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
5687 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
5688 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
5689 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
5690 int num;
5693 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
5694 const char *begin;
5695 const char *end;
5698 /* The comdat type node structure. */
5699 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
5701 dw_die_ref root_die;
5702 dw_die_ref type_die;
5703 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
5704 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
5706 comdat_type_node;
5708 /* The limbo die list structure. */
5709 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
5710 dw_die_ref die;
5711 tree created_for;
5712 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
5714 limbo_die_node;
5716 typedef struct GTY(()) skeleton_chain_struct
5718 dw_die_ref old_die;
5719 dw_die_ref new_die;
5720 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
5722 skeleton_chain_node;
5724 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
5725 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
5726 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
5727 #endif
5729 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
5730 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
5732 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
5733 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
5734 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
5735 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
5736 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
5737 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
5739 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
5740 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
5741 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
5742 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
5743 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
5744 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
5745 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
5746 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
5747 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
5748 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
5750 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
5751 language, and compiler version. */
5753 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
5754 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5755 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
5757 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
5758 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5759 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
5760 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
5762 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
5763 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
5765 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
5766 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
5767 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5768 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5769 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
5771 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
5772 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
5773 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
5774 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5775 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5776 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
5778 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
5779 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
5780 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
5781 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
5782 #else
5783 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
5784 #endif
5785 #endif
5787 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
5788 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
5789 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
5791 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
5792 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
5794 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
5795 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
5797 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
5798 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
5799 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
5800 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
5801 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
5803 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
5804 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
5805 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
5806 #endif
5808 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5809 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
5810 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
5811 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
5812 #endif
5814 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
5815 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
5817 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
5818 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
5820 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
5821 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
5823 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
5824 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
5825 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
5827 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
5828 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
5830 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
5831 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
5832 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
5834 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
5835 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
5836 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t common_block_die_table;
5838 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
5839 dw_die_ref die;
5840 tree arg;
5841 } die_arg_entry;
5843 DEF_VEC_O(die_arg_entry);
5844 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(die_arg_entry,gc);
5846 /* Node of the variable location list. */
5847 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
5848 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
5849 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
5850 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
5851 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
5852 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
5853 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
5854 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
5855 NULL as second operand. */
5856 rtx GTY (()) loc;
5857 const char * GTY (()) label;
5858 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
5861 /* Variable location list. */
5862 struct GTY (()) var_loc_list_def {
5863 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
5865 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
5866 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
5867 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
5868 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
5869 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
5870 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
5871 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
5873 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
5874 unsigned int decl_id;
5876 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
5879 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
5880 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
5882 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
5883 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
5884 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
5885 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
5886 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
5888 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
5889 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
5891 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
5892 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
5894 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5895 abbrev_die_table. */
5896 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
5898 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5899 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
5900 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
5901 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
5903 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
5904 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
5906 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
5907 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
5909 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5910 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
5911 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
5912 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
5914 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
5915 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
5917 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
5918 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
5920 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5921 line_info_table. */
5922 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
5924 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5925 accessible names. */
5926 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
5928 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5929 accessible types. */
5930 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
5932 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
5933 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
5935 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
5936 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
5938 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
5939 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
5941 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5942 arange_table. */
5943 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
5945 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
5946 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
5948 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
5949 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
5951 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
5952 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
5954 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
5955 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
5956 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
5958 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
5959 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
5961 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
5962 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
5964 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5965 ranges_table. */
5966 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
5968 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
5969 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
5971 /* Unique label counter. */
5972 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
5974 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
5975 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
5977 /* The direct call table structure. */
5979 typedef struct GTY(()) dcall_struct {
5980 unsigned int poc_label_num;
5981 tree poc_decl;
5982 dw_die_ref targ_die;
5984 dcall_entry;
5986 DEF_VEC_O(dcall_entry);
5987 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dcall_entry, gc);
5989 /* The virtual call table structure. */
5991 typedef struct GTY(()) vcall_struct {
5992 unsigned int poc_label_num;
5993 unsigned int vtable_slot;
5995 vcall_entry;
5997 DEF_VEC_O(vcall_entry);
5998 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(vcall_entry, gc);
6000 /* Pointers to the direct and virtual call tables. */
6001 static GTY (()) VEC (dcall_entry, gc) * dcall_table = NULL;
6002 static GTY (()) VEC (vcall_entry, gc) * vcall_table = NULL;
6004 /* A hash table to map INSN_UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
6006 struct GTY (()) vcall_insn {
6007 int insn_uid;
6008 unsigned int vtable_slot;
6011 static GTY ((param_is (struct vcall_insn))) htab_t vcall_insn_table;
6013 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
6014 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
6015 static int current_function_has_inlines;
6016 #endif
6017 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
6018 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
6019 #endif
6021 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
6022 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
6024 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
6025 static GTY(()) int label_num;
6027 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
6028 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
6030 static GTY(()) VEC(die_arg_entry,gc) *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
6032 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
6034 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
6035 within the current function. */
6036 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
6038 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
6040 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
6041 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
6042 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
6043 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
6044 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
6045 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
6046 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
6047 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
6048 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
6049 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
6050 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
6051 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
6052 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
6053 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
6054 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6055 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
6056 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6057 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6058 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
6059 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
6060 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
6061 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
6062 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
6063 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6064 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
6065 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
6066 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
6067 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6068 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
6069 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
6070 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
6071 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
6072 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
6073 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
6074 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6075 dw_loc_list_ref);
6076 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
6077 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
6078 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
6079 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6080 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6081 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6082 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6083 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6084 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6085 unsigned long);
6086 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
6087 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6088 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
6089 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
6090 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6091 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6092 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6093 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6094 static bool is_cxx (void);
6095 static bool is_fortran (void);
6096 static bool is_ada (void);
6097 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6098 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
6099 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6100 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
6101 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
6102 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6103 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
6104 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6105 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
6106 static hashval_t common_block_die_table_hash (const void *);
6107 static int common_block_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6108 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
6109 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6110 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
6111 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6112 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
6113 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
6114 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
6115 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
6116 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6117 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
6118 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6119 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6120 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6121 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
6122 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
6123 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6124 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
6125 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6126 struct checksum_attributes;
6127 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
6128 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6129 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6130 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
6131 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
6132 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
6133 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
6134 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
6135 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6136 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
6137 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
6138 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
6139 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
6140 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
6141 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
6142 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
6143 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
6144 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
6145 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
6146 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
6147 static void copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6148 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
6149 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
6150 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
6151 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
6152 dw_die_ref);
6153 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
6154 static dw_die_ref copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6155 static void copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6156 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
6158 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
6159 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
6160 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
6161 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
6162 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
6163 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
6164 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
6165 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
6166 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6167 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
6168 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
6169 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6170 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6171 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
6172 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6173 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
6174 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6175 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6176 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
6177 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
6178 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
6179 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
6180 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
6181 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
6182 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
6183 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
6184 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
6185 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
6186 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6187 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
6188 static void output_aranges (void);
6189 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
6190 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
6191 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
6192 bool *);
6193 static void output_ranges (void);
6194 static void output_line_info (void);
6195 static void output_file_names (void);
6196 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
6197 static int is_base_type (tree);
6198 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6199 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6200 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6201 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6202 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
6203 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
6204 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
6205 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
6206 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
6207 enum var_init_status);
6208 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6209 enum var_init_status);
6210 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
6211 enum var_init_status);
6212 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
6213 static int resolve_one_addr (rtx *, void *);
6214 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6215 enum var_init_status);
6216 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6217 enum var_init_status);
6218 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6219 enum var_init_status);
6220 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int);
6221 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
6222 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
6223 static tree field_type (const_tree);
6224 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6225 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6226 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
6227 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
6228 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6229 dw_loc_list_ref);
6230 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6231 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
6232 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
6233 static void insert_double (double_int, unsigned char *);
6234 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
6235 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
6236 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
6237 enum dwarf_attribute);
6238 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6239 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
6240 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
6241 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
6242 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
6243 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
6244 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6245 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6246 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6247 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6248 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6249 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6250 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6251 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6252 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
6253 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
6254 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
6255 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6256 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6257 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6258 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6259 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6260 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
6261 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
6262 #if 0
6263 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
6264 #endif
6265 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6266 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
6267 #if 0
6268 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6269 #endif
6270 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6271 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6272 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
6273 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6274 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6275 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6276 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6277 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6278 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6279 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6280 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6281 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6282 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6283 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
6284 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6285 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6286 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
6287 enum debug_info_usage);
6288 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6289 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6290 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6291 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6292 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6293 static int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
6294 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
6295 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
6296 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6297 static void gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6298 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
6299 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
6300 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
6301 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
6302 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
6303 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
6304 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6305 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
6306 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
6307 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
6308 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6309 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
6310 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
6311 const char *, const char *);
6312 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
6313 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
6315 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6316 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
6317 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
6318 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
6319 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
6320 static void prune_unused_types (void);
6321 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
6322 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref);
6323 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref);
6324 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6325 const char *, const char *);
6326 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
6327 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
6329 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
6330 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
6331 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
6332 #endif
6333 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
6334 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
6335 #endif
6336 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
6337 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
6338 #endif
6339 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
6340 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
6341 #endif
6342 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
6343 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
6344 #endif
6345 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
6346 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
6347 #endif
6348 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
6349 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
6350 #endif
6351 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
6352 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION ".debug_pubtypes"
6353 #endif
6354 #ifndef DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION
6355 #define DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION ".debug_dcall"
6356 #endif
6357 #ifndef DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION
6358 #define DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION ".debug_vcall"
6359 #endif
6360 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
6361 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
6362 #endif
6363 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
6364 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
6365 #endif
6367 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
6368 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6369 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
6370 #endif
6372 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
6373 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
6374 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
6375 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
6376 : SECTION_DEBUG)
6378 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
6379 the section names themselves. */
6381 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6382 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
6383 #endif
6384 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6385 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
6386 #endif
6387 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
6388 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
6389 #endif
6390 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
6391 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
6392 #endif
6393 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
6394 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
6395 #endif
6396 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
6397 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
6398 #endif
6399 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
6400 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
6401 #endif
6402 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
6403 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
6404 #endif
6407 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
6408 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
6409 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
6410 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
6411 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
6413 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6414 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6415 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6416 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6417 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6418 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6419 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6420 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6421 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6422 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6424 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
6425 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
6426 #endif
6427 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
6428 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
6429 #endif
6430 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
6431 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
6432 #endif
6433 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
6434 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
6435 #endif
6436 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
6437 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
6438 #endif
6439 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
6440 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
6441 #endif
6444 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
6445 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
6447 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
6449 void
6450 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
6452 demangle_name_func = func;
6455 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
6457 static inline int
6458 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
6460 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6461 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
6462 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
6465 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
6466 removed. */
6468 static inline tree
6469 type_main_variant (tree type)
6471 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6473 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
6474 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
6475 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
6476 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
6477 here. */
6478 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
6479 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
6480 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6482 return type;
6485 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
6487 static inline int
6488 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
6490 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
6492 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
6493 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
6496 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
6498 static const char *
6499 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
6501 switch (tag)
6503 case DW_TAG_padding:
6504 return "DW_TAG_padding";
6505 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6506 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
6507 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6508 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
6509 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
6510 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
6511 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6512 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
6513 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
6514 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
6515 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
6516 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
6517 case DW_TAG_label:
6518 return "DW_TAG_label";
6519 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
6520 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
6521 case DW_TAG_member:
6522 return "DW_TAG_member";
6523 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6524 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
6525 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6526 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
6527 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
6528 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
6529 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6530 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
6531 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6532 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
6533 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6534 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
6535 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6536 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
6537 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6538 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
6539 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
6540 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
6541 case DW_TAG_variant:
6542 return "DW_TAG_variant";
6543 case DW_TAG_common_block:
6544 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
6545 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
6546 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
6547 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
6548 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
6549 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
6550 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
6551 case DW_TAG_module:
6552 return "DW_TAG_module";
6553 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6554 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
6555 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6556 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
6557 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6558 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
6559 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
6560 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
6561 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
6562 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
6563 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6564 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
6565 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
6566 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
6567 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6568 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
6569 case DW_TAG_constant:
6570 return "DW_TAG_constant";
6571 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
6572 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
6573 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6574 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
6575 case DW_TAG_friend:
6576 return "DW_TAG_friend";
6577 case DW_TAG_namelist:
6578 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
6579 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
6580 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
6581 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6582 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
6583 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
6584 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
6585 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
6586 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
6587 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
6588 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
6589 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
6590 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
6591 case DW_TAG_try_block:
6592 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
6593 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
6594 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
6595 case DW_TAG_variable:
6596 return "DW_TAG_variable";
6597 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6598 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
6599 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
6600 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
6601 case DW_TAG_restrict_type:
6602 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
6603 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6604 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
6605 case DW_TAG_namespace:
6606 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
6607 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
6608 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
6609 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type:
6610 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
6611 case DW_TAG_partial_unit:
6612 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
6613 case DW_TAG_imported_unit:
6614 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
6615 case DW_TAG_condition:
6616 return "DW_TAG_condition";
6617 case DW_TAG_shared_type:
6618 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
6619 case DW_TAG_type_unit:
6620 return "DW_TAG_type_unit";
6621 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6622 return "DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type";
6623 case DW_TAG_template_alias:
6624 return "DW_TAG_template_alias";
6625 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
6626 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack";
6627 case DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack:
6628 return "DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack";
6629 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
6630 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
6631 case DW_TAG_format_label:
6632 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
6633 case DW_TAG_function_template:
6634 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
6635 case DW_TAG_class_template:
6636 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
6637 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
6638 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
6639 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
6640 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
6641 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
6642 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param";
6643 default:
6644 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
6648 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
6650 static const char *
6651 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
6653 switch (attr)
6655 case DW_AT_sibling:
6656 return "DW_AT_sibling";
6657 case DW_AT_location:
6658 return "DW_AT_location";
6659 case DW_AT_name:
6660 return "DW_AT_name";
6661 case DW_AT_ordering:
6662 return "DW_AT_ordering";
6663 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
6664 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
6665 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6666 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
6667 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6668 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
6669 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6670 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
6671 case DW_AT_element_list:
6672 return "DW_AT_element_list";
6673 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
6674 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
6675 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6676 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
6677 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6678 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
6679 case DW_AT_language:
6680 return "DW_AT_language";
6681 case DW_AT_member:
6682 return "DW_AT_member";
6683 case DW_AT_discr:
6684 return "DW_AT_discr";
6685 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6686 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
6687 case DW_AT_visibility:
6688 return "DW_AT_visibility";
6689 case DW_AT_import:
6690 return "DW_AT_import";
6691 case DW_AT_string_length:
6692 return "DW_AT_string_length";
6693 case DW_AT_common_reference:
6694 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
6695 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
6696 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
6697 case DW_AT_const_value:
6698 return "DW_AT_const_value";
6699 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6700 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
6701 case DW_AT_default_value:
6702 return "DW_AT_default_value";
6703 case DW_AT_inline:
6704 return "DW_AT_inline";
6705 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6706 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
6707 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6708 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
6709 case DW_AT_producer:
6710 return "DW_AT_producer";
6711 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6712 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
6713 case DW_AT_return_addr:
6714 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
6715 case DW_AT_start_scope:
6716 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
6717 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6718 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
6719 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6720 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
6721 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
6722 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
6723 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6724 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
6725 case DW_AT_address_class:
6726 return "DW_AT_address_class";
6727 case DW_AT_artificial:
6728 return "DW_AT_artificial";
6729 case DW_AT_base_types:
6730 return "DW_AT_base_types";
6731 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
6732 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
6733 case DW_AT_count:
6734 return "DW_AT_count";
6735 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6736 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
6737 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6738 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
6739 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6740 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
6741 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6742 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
6743 case DW_AT_declaration:
6744 return "DW_AT_declaration";
6745 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6746 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
6747 case DW_AT_encoding:
6748 return "DW_AT_encoding";
6749 case DW_AT_external:
6750 return "DW_AT_external";
6751 case DW_AT_explicit:
6752 return "DW_AT_explicit";
6753 case DW_AT_frame_base:
6754 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
6755 case DW_AT_friend:
6756 return "DW_AT_friend";
6757 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
6758 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
6759 case DW_AT_macro_info:
6760 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
6761 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
6762 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
6763 case DW_AT_priority:
6764 return "DW_AT_priority";
6765 case DW_AT_segment:
6766 return "DW_AT_segment";
6767 case DW_AT_specification:
6768 return "DW_AT_specification";
6769 case DW_AT_static_link:
6770 return "DW_AT_static_link";
6771 case DW_AT_type:
6772 return "DW_AT_type";
6773 case DW_AT_use_location:
6774 return "DW_AT_use_location";
6775 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6776 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
6777 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6778 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
6779 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6780 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
6782 case DW_AT_allocated:
6783 return "DW_AT_allocated";
6784 case DW_AT_associated:
6785 return "DW_AT_associated";
6786 case DW_AT_data_location:
6787 return "DW_AT_data_location";
6788 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6789 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
6790 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
6791 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
6792 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6793 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
6794 case DW_AT_extension:
6795 return "DW_AT_extension";
6796 case DW_AT_ranges:
6797 return "DW_AT_ranges";
6798 case DW_AT_trampoline:
6799 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
6800 case DW_AT_call_column:
6801 return "DW_AT_call_column";
6802 case DW_AT_call_file:
6803 return "DW_AT_call_file";
6804 case DW_AT_call_line:
6805 return "DW_AT_call_line";
6807 case DW_AT_signature:
6808 return "DW_AT_signature";
6809 case DW_AT_main_subprogram:
6810 return "DW_AT_main_subprogram";
6811 case DW_AT_data_bit_offset:
6812 return "DW_AT_data_bit_offset";
6813 case DW_AT_const_expr:
6814 return "DW_AT_const_expr";
6815 case DW_AT_enum_class:
6816 return "DW_AT_enum_class";
6817 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
6818 return "DW_AT_linkage_name";
6820 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
6821 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
6822 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
6823 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
6824 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
6825 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
6826 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
6827 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
6828 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
6829 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
6830 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
6831 #else
6832 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
6833 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
6834 #endif
6835 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
6836 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
6837 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
6838 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
6839 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
6840 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
6841 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
6842 #else
6843 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
6844 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
6845 #endif
6846 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
6847 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
6848 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
6849 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
6850 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
6851 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
6853 case DW_AT_sf_names:
6854 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
6855 case DW_AT_src_info:
6856 return "DW_AT_src_info";
6857 case DW_AT_mac_info:
6858 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
6859 case DW_AT_src_coords:
6860 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
6861 case DW_AT_body_begin:
6862 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
6863 case DW_AT_body_end:
6864 return "DW_AT_body_end";
6865 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
6866 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
6867 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by:
6868 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by";
6869 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by:
6870 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by";
6871 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded:
6872 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded";
6873 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded:
6874 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded";
6875 case DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded:
6876 return "DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded";
6877 case DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required:
6878 return "DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required";
6879 case DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required:
6880 return "DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required";
6881 case DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature:
6882 return "DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature";
6883 case DW_AT_GNU_template_name:
6884 return "DW_AT_GNU_template_name";
6886 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
6887 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
6889 default:
6890 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
6894 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
6896 static const char *
6897 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
6899 switch (form)
6901 case DW_FORM_addr:
6902 return "DW_FORM_addr";
6903 case DW_FORM_block2:
6904 return "DW_FORM_block2";
6905 case DW_FORM_block4:
6906 return "DW_FORM_block4";
6907 case DW_FORM_data2:
6908 return "DW_FORM_data2";
6909 case DW_FORM_data4:
6910 return "DW_FORM_data4";
6911 case DW_FORM_data8:
6912 return "DW_FORM_data8";
6913 case DW_FORM_string:
6914 return "DW_FORM_string";
6915 case DW_FORM_block:
6916 return "DW_FORM_block";
6917 case DW_FORM_block1:
6918 return "DW_FORM_block1";
6919 case DW_FORM_data1:
6920 return "DW_FORM_data1";
6921 case DW_FORM_flag:
6922 return "DW_FORM_flag";
6923 case DW_FORM_sdata:
6924 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
6925 case DW_FORM_strp:
6926 return "DW_FORM_strp";
6927 case DW_FORM_udata:
6928 return "DW_FORM_udata";
6929 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
6930 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
6931 case DW_FORM_ref1:
6932 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
6933 case DW_FORM_ref2:
6934 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
6935 case DW_FORM_ref4:
6936 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
6937 case DW_FORM_ref8:
6938 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
6939 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
6940 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
6941 case DW_FORM_indirect:
6942 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
6943 case DW_FORM_sec_offset:
6944 return "DW_FORM_sec_offset";
6945 case DW_FORM_exprloc:
6946 return "DW_FORM_exprloc";
6947 case DW_FORM_flag_present:
6948 return "DW_FORM_flag_present";
6949 case DW_FORM_ref_sig8:
6950 return "DW_FORM_ref_sig8";
6951 default:
6952 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
6956 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
6957 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
6958 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
6959 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
6960 given block. */
6962 static tree
6963 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
6965 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
6966 return NULL_TREE;
6968 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
6969 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
6970 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
6971 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
6972 return NULL_TREE;
6974 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
6975 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
6976 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
6978 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
6981 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
6982 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
6983 parameter. */
6985 static tree
6986 decl_class_context (tree decl)
6988 tree context = NULL_TREE;
6990 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
6991 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
6992 else
6993 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
6994 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
6996 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
6997 context = NULL_TREE;
6999 return context;
7002 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
7004 static inline void
7005 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
7007 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
7008 if (die == NULL)
7009 return;
7011 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
7012 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
7013 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
7016 static inline enum dw_val_class
7017 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
7019 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
7022 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
7024 static inline void
7025 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
7027 dw_attr_node attr;
7029 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7030 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
7031 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
7032 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7035 static inline unsigned
7036 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
7038 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
7039 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
7042 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7044 static inline void
7045 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
7047 dw_attr_node attr;
7049 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7050 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
7051 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
7052 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7055 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
7056 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
7058 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
7059 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
7062 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7064 static inline void
7065 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7066 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
7068 dw_attr_node attr;
7070 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7071 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
7072 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
7073 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7076 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7077 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
7079 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
7080 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
7083 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7085 static inline void
7086 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7087 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
7089 dw_attr_node attr;
7091 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7092 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
7093 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
7094 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
7095 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7098 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
7100 static inline void
7101 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7102 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
7104 dw_attr_node attr;
7106 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7107 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
7108 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
7109 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
7110 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
7111 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7114 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
7116 static inline void
7117 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7118 unsigned char data8[8])
7120 dw_attr_node attr;
7122 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7123 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
7124 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
7125 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7128 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
7130 static hashval_t
7131 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
7133 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
7136 static int
7137 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
7139 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
7140 (const char *)x2) == 0;
7143 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
7145 static struct indirect_string_node *
7146 find_AT_string (const char *str)
7148 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7149 void **slot;
7151 if (! debug_str_hash)
7152 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
7153 debug_str_eq, NULL);
7155 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
7156 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
7157 if (*slot == NULL)
7159 node = ggc_alloc_cleared_indirect_string_node ();
7160 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
7161 *slot = node;
7163 else
7164 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
7166 node->refcount++;
7167 return node;
7170 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
7172 static inline void
7173 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
7175 dw_attr_node attr;
7176 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7178 node = find_AT_string (str);
7180 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7181 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
7182 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
7183 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7186 /* Create a label for an indirect string node, ensuring it is going to
7187 be output, unless its reference count goes down to zero. */
7189 static inline void
7190 gen_label_for_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
7192 char label[32];
7194 if (node->label)
7195 return;
7197 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
7198 ++dw2_string_counter;
7199 node->label = xstrdup (label);
7202 /* Create a SYMBOL_REF rtx whose value is the initial address of a
7203 debug string STR. */
7205 static inline rtx
7206 get_debug_string_label (const char *str)
7208 struct indirect_string_node *node = find_AT_string (str);
7210 debug_str_hash_forced = true;
7212 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7214 return gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, node->label);
7217 static inline const char *
7218 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
7220 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7221 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
7224 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
7225 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
7227 static enum dwarf_form
7228 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
7230 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7231 unsigned int len;
7233 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7235 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
7236 if (node->form)
7237 return node->form;
7239 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
7241 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
7242 always better to put it inline. */
7243 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
7244 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7246 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
7247 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
7248 single module. */
7249 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
7250 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
7251 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
7252 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7254 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7256 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
7259 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7261 static inline void
7262 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7264 dw_attr_node attr;
7266 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7267 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
7268 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
7269 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
7270 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7273 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
7274 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
7276 static inline void
7277 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7279 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
7280 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
7281 targ_die->die_definition = die;
7284 static inline dw_die_ref
7285 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
7287 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7288 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
7291 static inline int
7292 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
7294 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7295 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
7297 return 0;
7300 static inline void
7301 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
7303 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7304 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
7307 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7309 static inline void
7310 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
7312 dw_attr_node attr;
7314 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7315 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
7316 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
7317 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7320 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
7322 static inline void
7323 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
7325 dw_attr_node attr;
7327 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7328 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
7329 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
7330 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7333 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
7334 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
7336 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7337 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
7340 static inline void
7341 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
7343 dw_attr_node attr;
7345 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7346 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
7347 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
7348 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7349 have_location_lists = true;
7352 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7353 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
7355 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7356 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7359 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
7360 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_ref a)
7362 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7363 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7366 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
7368 static inline void
7369 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
7371 dw_attr_node attr;
7373 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7374 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7375 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
7376 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7379 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
7381 static inline rtx
7382 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
7384 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
7385 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
7388 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
7390 static inline void
7391 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7392 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
7394 dw_attr_node attr;
7396 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7397 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
7398 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
7399 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7402 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
7404 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7405 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
7407 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
7408 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
7411 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
7413 static inline void
7414 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7415 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
7417 dw_attr_node attr;
7419 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7420 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
7421 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
7422 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
7423 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7426 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
7428 static inline void
7429 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
7431 dw_attr_node attr;
7433 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7434 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
7435 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
7436 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7439 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7440 debug_line section. */
7442 static inline void
7443 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7444 const char *label)
7446 dw_attr_node attr;
7448 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7449 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
7450 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7451 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7454 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7455 debug_macinfo section. */
7457 static inline void
7458 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7459 const char *label)
7461 dw_attr_node attr;
7463 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7464 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
7465 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7466 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7469 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
7471 static inline void
7472 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7473 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7475 dw_attr_node attr;
7477 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7478 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
7479 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7480 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7483 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
7485 static void
7486 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7487 long unsigned int offset)
7489 dw_attr_node attr;
7491 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7492 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
7493 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7494 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7497 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
7499 static inline const char *
7500 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref a)
7502 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
7503 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
7506 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
7508 static inline const char *
7509 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref a)
7511 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
7512 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
7515 static inline const char *
7516 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
7518 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
7519 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
7520 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
7521 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
7524 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
7526 static dw_attr_ref
7527 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7529 dw_attr_ref a;
7530 unsigned ix;
7531 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
7533 if (! die)
7534 return NULL;
7536 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7537 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7538 return a;
7539 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
7540 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7541 spec = AT_ref (a);
7543 if (spec)
7544 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
7546 return NULL;
7549 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7550 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7551 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7553 static inline const char *
7554 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7556 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
7558 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7561 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7562 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7563 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7565 static inline const char *
7566 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7568 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
7570 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7573 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
7574 NULL if it is not present. */
7576 static inline const char *
7577 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7579 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7581 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
7584 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
7585 if it is not present. */
7587 static inline int
7588 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7590 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7592 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
7595 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
7596 if it is not present. */
7598 static inline unsigned
7599 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7601 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7603 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
7606 static inline dw_die_ref
7607 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7609 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7611 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
7614 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7615 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7617 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7619 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
7622 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
7624 static inline bool
7625 is_cxx (void)
7627 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7629 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
7632 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
7634 static inline bool
7635 is_fortran (void)
7637 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7639 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
7640 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
7641 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
7644 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
7646 static inline bool
7647 is_ada (void)
7649 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7651 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
7654 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
7656 static void
7657 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7659 dw_attr_ref a;
7660 unsigned ix;
7662 if (! die)
7663 return;
7665 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7666 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7668 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
7669 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
7670 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
7672 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
7673 that are needed. */
7674 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
7675 return;
7679 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
7680 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
7682 static void
7683 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
7685 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
7686 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
7687 if (prev == child)
7689 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
7690 prev = NULL;
7692 else
7693 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
7694 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
7695 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
7698 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
7699 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
7701 static void
7702 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
7704 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
7706 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
7707 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
7709 new_child->die_parent = parent;
7710 if (prev == old_child)
7712 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
7713 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
7715 else
7717 prev->die_sib = new_child;
7718 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
7720 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
7721 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
7724 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
7726 static void
7727 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
7729 dw_die_ref c;
7730 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
7731 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
7732 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
7735 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
7736 matches TAG. */
7738 static void
7739 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
7741 dw_die_ref c;
7743 c = die->die_child;
7744 if (c) do {
7745 dw_die_ref prev = c;
7746 c = c->die_sib;
7747 while (c->die_tag == tag)
7749 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7750 /* Might have removed every child. */
7751 if (c == c->die_sib)
7752 return;
7753 c = c->die_sib;
7755 } while (c != die->die_child);
7758 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
7760 static void
7761 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
7763 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
7764 if (! die || ! child_die)
7765 return;
7766 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
7768 child_die->die_parent = die;
7769 if (die->die_child)
7771 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
7772 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
7774 else
7775 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
7776 die->die_child = child_die;
7779 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
7780 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
7781 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
7783 static void
7784 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
7786 dw_die_ref p;
7788 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
7789 specification DIE at toplevel. */
7790 if (child->die_parent != parent)
7792 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
7794 if (tmp)
7795 child = tmp;
7798 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
7799 || (child->die_parent
7800 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
7802 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
7803 if (p->die_sib == child)
7805 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
7806 break;
7809 add_child_die (parent, child);
7812 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
7814 static inline dw_die_ref
7815 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
7817 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
7819 die->die_tag = tag_value;
7821 if (parent_die != NULL)
7822 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
7823 else
7825 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
7827 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
7828 limbo_node->die = die;
7829 limbo_node->created_for = t;
7830 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
7831 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
7834 return die;
7837 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
7839 static inline dw_die_ref
7840 lookup_type_die (tree type)
7842 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
7845 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
7847 static inline void
7848 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
7850 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
7853 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
7855 static hashval_t
7856 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
7858 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
7861 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
7863 static int
7864 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7866 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7869 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
7871 static inline dw_die_ref
7872 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
7874 return (dw_die_ref) htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7877 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
7879 static hashval_t
7880 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
7882 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
7885 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
7886 UID of decl *Y. */
7888 static int
7889 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7891 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7894 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
7896 static inline var_loc_list *
7897 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
7899 if (!decl_loc_table)
7900 return NULL;
7901 return (var_loc_list *)
7902 htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7905 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
7907 static void
7908 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
7910 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
7911 void **slot;
7913 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
7914 *slot = decl_die;
7915 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
7918 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
7920 static int
7921 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
7923 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
7924 if (ret)
7925 return ret;
7926 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
7927 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
7928 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
7931 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
7933 static rtx *
7934 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
7936 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
7937 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
7938 else
7939 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
7942 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
7943 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
7945 static rtx
7946 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
7948 if (bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
7949 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
7950 else
7951 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
7952 GEN_INT (bitsize),
7953 loc_note), next);
7956 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
7957 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
7959 static rtx
7960 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
7961 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
7963 if (bitsize != -1)
7965 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
7966 if (bitpos != 0)
7967 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
7969 return loc_note;
7972 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
7973 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
7974 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
7975 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
7976 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
7977 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
7978 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
7979 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
7980 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
7982 static void
7983 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
7984 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
7985 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
7987 int diff;
7988 bool copy = inner != NULL;
7990 if (copy)
7992 /* First copy all nodes preceeding the current bitpos. */
7993 while (src != inner)
7995 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
7996 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
7997 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
7998 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
8001 /* Add padding if needed. */
8002 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
8004 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
8005 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8006 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8008 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
8010 gcc_assert (!copy);
8011 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
8012 just update the location for it and return. */
8013 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
8014 return;
8016 /* Add the piece that changed. */
8017 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8018 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8019 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
8020 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
8021 if (!copy)
8022 src = dest;
8023 while (diff > 0 && *src)
8025 rtx piece = *src;
8026 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
8027 if (copy)
8028 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
8029 else
8031 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
8032 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
8035 /* Add padding if needed. */
8036 if (diff < 0 && *src)
8038 if (!copy)
8039 dest = src;
8040 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8041 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8043 if (!copy)
8044 return;
8045 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
8046 while (*src)
8048 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
8049 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
8050 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8051 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
8055 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
8057 static struct var_loc_node *
8058 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
8060 unsigned int decl_id;
8061 var_loc_list *temp;
8062 void **slot;
8063 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
8064 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
8066 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl))
8068 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
8069 if (realdecl && handled_component_p (realdecl))
8071 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
8072 tree innerdecl;
8073 innerdecl
8074 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize);
8075 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
8076 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
8077 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
8078 || bitsize <= 0
8079 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
8080 || bitsize != maxsize)
8081 return NULL;
8082 decl = innerdecl;
8086 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
8087 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
8088 if (*slot == NULL)
8090 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_list ();
8091 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
8092 *slot = temp;
8094 else
8095 temp = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
8097 if (temp->last)
8099 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
8100 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
8101 int piece_bitpos = 0;
8102 if (last->next)
8104 last = last->next;
8105 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
8107 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
8109 piece_loc = &last->loc;
8112 int cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
8113 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
8114 break;
8115 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
8116 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
8118 while (*piece_loc);
8120 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
8121 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
8122 last element. */
8123 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
8125 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
8126 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
8127 if (piece_loc != NULL)
8129 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
8130 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
8131 return NULL;
8133 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
8134 if (temp->last != last)
8136 temp->last->next = NULL;
8137 unused = last;
8138 last = temp->last;
8139 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
8141 else
8143 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last);
8144 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
8145 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8146 return temp->last;
8149 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
8150 last_loc_note = last->loc;
8151 else if (piece_loc != NULL
8152 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
8153 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
8154 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
8155 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
8156 else
8157 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
8158 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
8159 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
8160 we have nothing to do. */
8161 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
8162 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
8163 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
8164 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
8165 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
8166 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
8167 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
8168 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
8169 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
8171 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
8172 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
8173 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
8174 if (unused)
8176 loc = unused;
8177 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
8179 else
8180 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
8181 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
8182 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8183 else
8184 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
8185 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
8186 last->next = loc;
8187 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
8188 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
8189 if (last != temp->last)
8190 temp->last = last;
8192 else if (unused)
8193 ggc_free (unused);
8195 else
8197 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
8198 temp->first = loc;
8199 temp->last = loc;
8200 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8202 return loc;
8205 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
8206 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
8207 the DIE internal representation. */
8208 static int print_indent;
8210 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
8212 static inline void
8213 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
8215 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
8218 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
8220 static inline void
8221 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
8223 int i;
8225 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
8226 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
8229 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
8230 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8232 static void
8233 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
8235 dw_attr_ref a;
8236 dw_die_ref c;
8237 unsigned ix;
8239 print_spaces (outfile);
8240 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
8241 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
8242 print_spaces (outfile);
8243 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
8244 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
8245 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && die->die_id.die_type_node)
8247 print_spaces (outfile);
8248 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
8249 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
8250 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8253 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8255 print_spaces (outfile);
8256 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
8258 switch (AT_class (a))
8260 case dw_val_class_addr:
8261 fprintf (outfile, "address");
8262 break;
8263 case dw_val_class_offset:
8264 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
8265 break;
8266 case dw_val_class_loc:
8267 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
8268 break;
8269 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8270 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
8271 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
8272 break;
8273 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8274 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
8275 break;
8276 case dw_val_class_const:
8277 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
8278 break;
8279 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8280 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
8281 break;
8282 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8283 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
8284 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
8285 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high,
8286 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low);
8287 break;
8288 case dw_val_class_vec:
8289 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
8290 break;
8291 case dw_val_class_flag:
8292 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
8293 break;
8294 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8295 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
8297 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node)
8299 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
8300 print_signature (outfile,
8301 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
8303 else if (dwarf_version < 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol)
8304 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s",
8305 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8306 else
8307 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
8309 else
8310 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
8311 break;
8312 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8313 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
8314 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a));
8315 break;
8316 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8317 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8318 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8319 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
8320 break;
8321 case dw_val_class_str:
8322 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
8323 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
8324 else
8325 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
8326 break;
8327 case dw_val_class_file:
8328 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
8329 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
8330 break;
8331 case dw_val_class_data8:
8333 int i;
8335 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8336 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i]);
8337 break;
8339 default:
8340 break;
8343 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8346 if (die->die_child != NULL)
8348 print_indent += 4;
8349 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
8350 print_indent -= 4;
8352 if (print_indent == 0)
8353 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8356 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
8357 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8359 static void
8360 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
8362 unsigned i;
8363 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
8365 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
8366 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
8368 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
8369 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
8370 line_info->dw_file_num,
8371 line_info->dw_line_num);
8374 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
8377 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
8379 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
8380 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
8382 print_die (die, stderr);
8385 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
8386 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8388 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
8389 debug_dwarf (void)
8391 print_indent = 0;
8392 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
8393 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
8394 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
8397 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
8398 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
8399 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
8401 static dw_die_ref
8402 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
8404 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
8405 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
8407 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
8408 return new_unit;
8411 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
8413 static dw_die_ref
8414 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
8416 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
8418 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
8419 return new_unit;
8422 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8423 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
8425 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8427 static inline void
8428 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8430 int tem;
8432 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
8433 CHECKSUM (tem);
8434 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8435 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8438 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8440 static void
8441 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8443 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8444 rtx r;
8446 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
8448 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8449 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8450 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8451 return;
8453 switch (AT_class (at))
8455 case dw_val_class_const:
8456 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8457 break;
8458 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8459 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8460 break;
8461 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8462 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8463 break;
8464 case dw_val_class_vec:
8465 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8466 break;
8467 case dw_val_class_flag:
8468 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
8469 break;
8470 case dw_val_class_str:
8471 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8472 break;
8474 case dw_val_class_addr:
8475 r = AT_addr (at);
8476 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8477 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8478 break;
8480 case dw_val_class_offset:
8481 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8482 break;
8484 case dw_val_class_loc:
8485 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8486 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
8487 break;
8489 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8490 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
8491 break;
8493 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8494 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8495 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8496 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8497 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8498 break;
8500 case dw_val_class_file:
8501 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8502 break;
8504 case dw_val_class_data8:
8505 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8506 break;
8508 default:
8509 break;
8513 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
8515 static void
8516 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8518 dw_die_ref c;
8519 dw_attr_ref a;
8520 unsigned ix;
8522 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
8523 if (die->die_mark)
8525 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
8526 return;
8528 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8530 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
8532 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8533 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
8535 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
8538 #undef CHECKSUM
8539 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
8541 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
8542 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8543 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
8544 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8545 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8546 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
8547 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
8549 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
8551 static void
8552 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8554 unsigned char byte;
8555 bool more;
8557 while (1)
8559 byte = (value & 0x7f);
8560 value >>= 7;
8561 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
8562 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
8563 if (more)
8564 byte |= 0x80;
8565 CHECKSUM (byte);
8566 if (!more)
8567 break;
8571 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
8573 static void
8574 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8576 while (1)
8578 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
8579 value >>= 7;
8580 if (value != 0)
8581 /* More bytes to follow. */
8582 byte |= 0x80;
8583 CHECKSUM (byte);
8584 if (value == 0)
8585 break;
8589 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
8590 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
8592 static void
8593 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8595 const char *name;
8596 dw_die_ref spec;
8597 int tag = die->die_tag;
8599 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
8600 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
8601 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
8602 return;
8604 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
8606 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8607 if (spec != NULL)
8608 die = spec;
8610 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
8611 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
8613 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
8614 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
8615 if (name != NULL)
8616 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
8619 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8621 static inline void
8622 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8624 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
8625 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
8626 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
8628 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8629 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
8630 return;
8633 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
8634 while (loc != NULL)
8636 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
8637 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8638 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8639 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
8643 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8645 static void
8646 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
8647 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8649 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8650 rtx r;
8652 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8654 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
8656 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
8657 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
8658 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
8659 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
8660 is complete or not. */
8661 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
8662 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
8663 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
8664 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
8665 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
8666 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
8667 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
8669 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
8671 if (name_attr != NULL)
8673 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8675 if (decl == NULL)
8676 decl = target_die;
8677 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
8678 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8679 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8680 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8681 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
8682 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
8683 return;
8687 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
8688 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
8689 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
8690 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
8692 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
8693 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8694 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
8696 else
8698 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8700 if (decl == NULL)
8701 decl = target_die;
8702 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8703 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
8704 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8705 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8706 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8707 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
8709 return;
8712 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
8713 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8715 switch (AT_class (at))
8717 case dw_val_class_const:
8718 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8719 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8720 break;
8722 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8723 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8724 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8725 break;
8727 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8728 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8729 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
8730 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8731 break;
8733 case dw_val_class_vec:
8734 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8735 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec));
8736 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8737 break;
8739 case dw_val_class_flag:
8740 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
8741 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
8742 break;
8744 case dw_val_class_str:
8745 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8746 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8747 break;
8749 case dw_val_class_addr:
8750 r = AT_addr (at);
8751 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8752 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8753 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8754 break;
8756 case dw_val_class_offset:
8757 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8758 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8759 break;
8761 case dw_val_class_loc:
8762 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8763 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
8764 break;
8766 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8767 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8768 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8769 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8770 break;
8772 case dw_val_class_file:
8773 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8774 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8775 break;
8777 case dw_val_class_data8:
8778 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8779 break;
8781 default:
8782 break;
8786 struct checksum_attributes
8788 dw_attr_ref at_name;
8789 dw_attr_ref at_type;
8790 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
8791 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
8792 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
8793 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
8794 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
8795 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
8796 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
8797 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
8798 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
8799 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
8800 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
8801 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
8802 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
8803 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
8804 dw_attr_ref at_count;
8805 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
8806 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
8807 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
8808 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
8809 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
8810 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
8811 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
8812 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
8813 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
8814 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
8815 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
8816 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
8817 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
8818 dw_attr_ref at_location;
8819 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
8820 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
8821 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
8822 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
8823 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
8824 dw_attr_ref at_small;
8825 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
8826 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
8827 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
8828 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
8829 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
8830 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
8831 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
8832 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
8833 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
8834 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
8837 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
8839 static void
8840 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
8842 dw_attr_ref a;
8843 unsigned ix;
8845 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8847 switch (a->dw_attr)
8849 case DW_AT_name:
8850 attrs->at_name = a;
8851 break;
8852 case DW_AT_type:
8853 attrs->at_type = a;
8854 break;
8855 case DW_AT_friend:
8856 attrs->at_friend = a;
8857 break;
8858 case DW_AT_accessibility:
8859 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
8860 break;
8861 case DW_AT_address_class:
8862 attrs->at_address_class = a;
8863 break;
8864 case DW_AT_allocated:
8865 attrs->at_allocated = a;
8866 break;
8867 case DW_AT_artificial:
8868 attrs->at_artificial = a;
8869 break;
8870 case DW_AT_associated:
8871 attrs->at_associated = a;
8872 break;
8873 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
8874 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
8875 break;
8876 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
8877 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
8878 break;
8879 case DW_AT_bit_size:
8880 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
8881 break;
8882 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
8883 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
8884 break;
8885 case DW_AT_byte_size:
8886 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
8887 break;
8888 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
8889 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
8890 break;
8891 case DW_AT_const_value:
8892 attrs->at_const_value = a;
8893 break;
8894 case DW_AT_containing_type:
8895 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
8896 break;
8897 case DW_AT_count:
8898 attrs->at_count = a;
8899 break;
8900 case DW_AT_data_location:
8901 attrs->at_data_location = a;
8902 break;
8903 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
8904 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
8905 break;
8906 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
8907 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
8908 break;
8909 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
8910 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
8911 break;
8912 case DW_AT_default_value:
8913 attrs->at_default_value = a;
8914 break;
8915 case DW_AT_digit_count:
8916 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
8917 break;
8918 case DW_AT_discr:
8919 attrs->at_discr = a;
8920 break;
8921 case DW_AT_discr_list:
8922 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
8923 break;
8924 case DW_AT_discr_value:
8925 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
8926 break;
8927 case DW_AT_encoding:
8928 attrs->at_encoding = a;
8929 break;
8930 case DW_AT_endianity:
8931 attrs->at_endianity = a;
8932 break;
8933 case DW_AT_explicit:
8934 attrs->at_explicit = a;
8935 break;
8936 case DW_AT_is_optional:
8937 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
8938 break;
8939 case DW_AT_location:
8940 attrs->at_location = a;
8941 break;
8942 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
8943 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
8944 break;
8945 case DW_AT_mutable:
8946 attrs->at_mutable = a;
8947 break;
8948 case DW_AT_ordering:
8949 attrs->at_ordering = a;
8950 break;
8951 case DW_AT_picture_string:
8952 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
8953 break;
8954 case DW_AT_prototyped:
8955 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
8956 break;
8957 case DW_AT_small:
8958 attrs->at_small = a;
8959 break;
8960 case DW_AT_segment:
8961 attrs->at_segment = a;
8962 break;
8963 case DW_AT_string_length:
8964 attrs->at_string_length = a;
8965 break;
8966 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
8967 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
8968 break;
8969 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
8970 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
8971 break;
8972 case DW_AT_use_location:
8973 attrs->at_use_location = a;
8974 break;
8975 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
8976 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
8977 break;
8978 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
8979 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
8980 break;
8981 case DW_AT_virtuality:
8982 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
8983 break;
8984 case DW_AT_visibility:
8985 attrs->at_visibility = a;
8986 break;
8987 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
8988 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
8989 break;
8990 default:
8991 break;
8996 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
8998 static void
8999 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
9001 dw_die_ref c;
9002 dw_die_ref decl;
9003 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
9005 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
9006 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
9008 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
9010 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9011 if (decl != NULL)
9012 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
9013 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
9015 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
9016 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
9017 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
9018 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
9019 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
9020 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
9021 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
9022 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
9023 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
9024 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
9025 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
9026 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
9027 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
9028 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
9029 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
9030 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
9031 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
9032 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
9033 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
9034 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
9035 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
9036 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
9037 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
9038 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
9039 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
9040 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
9041 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
9042 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
9043 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
9044 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
9045 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
9046 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
9047 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
9048 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
9049 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
9050 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
9051 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
9052 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
9053 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
9054 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
9055 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
9056 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
9057 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
9058 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
9059 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
9060 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
9061 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
9063 /* Checksum the child DIEs, except for nested types and member functions. */
9064 c = die->die_child;
9065 if (c) do {
9066 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
9068 c = c->die_sib;
9069 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
9070 if ((is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
9071 && name_attr != NULL)
9073 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
9074 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
9075 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
9077 else
9079 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
9080 if (c->die_mark == 0)
9081 c->die_mark = -1;
9082 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
9084 } while (c != die->die_child);
9086 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
9089 #undef CHECKSUM
9090 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
9091 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
9092 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
9093 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
9095 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
9096 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
9097 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
9098 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
9099 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
9100 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
9101 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
9103 static void
9104 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
9106 int mark;
9107 const char *name;
9108 unsigned char checksum[16];
9109 struct md5_ctx ctx;
9110 dw_die_ref decl;
9112 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
9113 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9115 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
9116 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
9117 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
9119 if (is_cxx() && name != NULL)
9121 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9123 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
9124 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
9125 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
9127 md5_process_bytes (&die->die_tag, sizeof (die->die_tag), &ctx);
9128 md5_process_bytes (name, strlen (name) + 1, &ctx);
9129 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9131 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
9134 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
9136 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9137 mark = 1;
9138 die->die_mark = mark;
9140 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
9141 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
9142 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
9144 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
9145 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
9146 unmark_all_dies (die);
9147 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9149 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
9150 type node together. */
9151 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
9152 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
9153 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
9154 type_node->type_die = die;
9156 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
9157 as well. */
9158 if (decl != NULL)
9159 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
9162 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
9163 static inline int
9164 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
9166 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
9167 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
9168 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
9171 /* Do the values look the same? */
9172 static int
9173 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
9175 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
9176 rtx r1, r2;
9178 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
9179 return 0;
9181 switch (v1->val_class)
9183 case dw_val_class_const:
9184 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
9185 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9186 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
9187 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9188 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
9189 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
9190 case dw_val_class_vec:
9191 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
9192 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
9193 return 0;
9194 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
9195 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
9196 return 0;
9197 return 1;
9198 case dw_val_class_flag:
9199 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
9200 case dw_val_class_str:
9201 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
9203 case dw_val_class_addr:
9204 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
9205 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
9206 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
9207 return 0;
9208 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
9210 case dw_val_class_offset:
9211 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
9213 case dw_val_class_loc:
9214 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
9215 loc1 && loc2;
9216 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
9217 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
9218 return 0;
9219 return !loc1 && !loc2;
9221 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9222 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
9224 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9225 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9226 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9227 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9228 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9229 return 1;
9231 case dw_val_class_file:
9232 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
9234 case dw_val_class_data8:
9235 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
9237 default:
9238 return 1;
9242 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
9244 static int
9245 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
9247 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
9248 return 0;
9250 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
9251 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
9252 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
9253 return 1;
9255 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
9258 /* Do the dies look the same? */
9260 static int
9261 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
9263 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
9264 dw_attr_ref a1;
9265 unsigned ix;
9267 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
9268 if (die1->die_mark)
9269 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
9270 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
9272 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
9273 return 0;
9275 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
9276 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
9277 return 0;
9279 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
9280 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
9281 return 0;
9283 c1 = die1->die_child;
9284 c2 = die2->die_child;
9285 if (! c1)
9287 if (c2)
9288 return 0;
9290 else
9291 for (;;)
9293 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
9294 return 0;
9295 c1 = c1->die_sib;
9296 c2 = c2->die_sib;
9297 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
9299 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
9300 break;
9301 else
9302 return 0;
9306 return 1;
9309 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
9311 static int
9312 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
9314 int mark = 0;
9315 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
9317 unmark_all_dies (die1);
9318 unmark_all_dies (die2);
9320 return ret;
9323 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
9324 info section. */
9325 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
9327 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
9328 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
9330 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
9331 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
9333 static void
9334 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
9336 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
9337 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
9338 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
9339 char *p;
9340 int i, mark;
9341 unsigned char checksum[16];
9342 struct md5_ctx ctx;
9344 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
9345 the name filename of the unit. */
9347 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9348 mark = 0;
9349 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
9350 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
9351 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9353 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
9354 clean_symbol_name (name);
9356 p = name + strlen (name);
9357 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
9359 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
9360 p += 2;
9363 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
9364 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
9367 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
9369 static int
9370 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
9372 switch (die->die_tag)
9374 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9375 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9376 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9377 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9378 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9379 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9380 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
9381 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9382 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9383 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9384 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9385 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9386 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9387 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9388 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9389 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9390 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9391 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9392 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9393 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9394 return 1;
9395 default:
9396 return 0;
9400 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
9401 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
9402 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
9403 compilations (functions). */
9405 static int
9406 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
9408 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
9409 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
9410 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
9411 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
9413 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
9414 return 0;
9416 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
9417 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
9418 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
9419 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
9420 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
9422 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
9424 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
9427 return is_type_die (c);
9430 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
9431 compilation unit. */
9433 static int
9434 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
9436 return (is_type_die (c)
9437 || is_declaration_die (c)
9438 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9439 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
9442 static char *
9443 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
9445 char buf[256];
9447 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
9448 return xstrdup (buf);
9451 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
9453 static void
9454 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
9456 dw_die_ref c;
9458 if (is_symbol_die (die))
9460 if (comdat_symbol_id)
9462 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
9464 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
9465 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
9466 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
9468 else
9469 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
9472 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
9475 struct cu_hash_table_entry
9477 dw_die_ref cu;
9478 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
9479 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
9482 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
9483 static hashval_t
9484 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
9486 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry =
9487 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of;
9489 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
9492 static int
9493 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
9495 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry1 =
9496 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of1;
9497 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
9499 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
9502 static void
9503 htab_cu_del (void *what)
9505 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next,
9506 *entry = (struct cu_hash_table_entry *) what;
9508 while (entry)
9510 next = entry->next;
9511 free (entry);
9512 entry = next;
9516 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
9517 accordingly. */
9518 static int
9519 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
9521 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
9522 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
9524 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
9526 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9527 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9528 INSERT);
9529 entry = *slot;
9531 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
9533 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
9534 break;
9537 if (entry)
9539 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
9540 return 1;
9543 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
9544 entry->cu = cu;
9545 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
9546 entry->next = *slot;
9547 *slot = entry;
9549 return 0;
9552 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
9553 static void
9554 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
9556 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
9558 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9559 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9560 NO_INSERT);
9561 entry = *slot;
9563 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
9566 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
9567 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
9568 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
9570 static void
9571 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
9573 dw_die_ref c;
9574 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9575 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
9576 htab_t cu_hash_table;
9578 c = die->die_child;
9579 if (c) do {
9580 dw_die_ref prev = c;
9581 c = c->die_sib;
9582 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
9583 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
9585 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
9587 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
9588 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
9590 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
9591 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
9592 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
9593 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
9594 else
9595 add_child_die (unit, c);
9596 c = next;
9597 if (c == die->die_child)
9598 break;
9600 } while (c != die->die_child);
9602 #if 0
9603 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
9604 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
9605 gcc_assert (!unit);
9606 #endif
9608 assign_symbol_names (die);
9609 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
9610 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
9611 node;
9612 node = node->next)
9614 int is_dupl;
9616 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
9617 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9618 &comdat_symbol_number);
9619 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
9620 if (is_dupl)
9621 *pnode = node->next;
9622 else
9624 pnode = &node->next;
9625 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9626 comdat_symbol_number);
9629 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
9632 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
9634 static int
9635 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
9637 dw_attr_ref a;
9638 unsigned ix;
9640 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9641 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
9642 return 1;
9644 return 0;
9647 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
9649 static int
9650 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
9652 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9654 if (decl == NULL)
9655 decl = die;
9656 return local_scope_p (decl);
9659 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
9660 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
9662 static int
9663 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
9665 switch (die->die_tag)
9667 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9668 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9669 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9670 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9671 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, or types nested in a
9672 subprogram. */
9673 if (is_declaration_die (die)
9674 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
9675 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die))
9676 return 0;
9677 return 1;
9678 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9679 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9680 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9681 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9682 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
9683 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9684 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9685 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9686 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9687 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9688 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9689 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9690 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9691 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9692 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9693 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9694 default:
9695 return 0;
9699 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
9701 static dw_die_ref
9702 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
9704 dw_die_ref clone;
9705 dw_attr_ref a;
9706 unsigned ix;
9708 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
9709 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9711 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9712 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9714 return clone;
9717 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
9719 static dw_die_ref
9720 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
9722 dw_die_ref c;
9723 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
9725 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree(c)));
9727 return clone;
9730 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
9732 static dw_die_ref
9733 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
9735 dw_die_ref clone;
9736 dw_die_ref decl;
9737 dw_attr_ref a;
9738 unsigned ix;
9740 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
9741 if (is_declaration_die (die))
9742 return clone_die (die);
9744 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
9745 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9746 if (decl != NULL)
9747 return clone_die (decl);
9749 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
9750 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9752 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9754 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
9755 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
9756 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
9758 switch (a->dw_attr)
9760 case DW_AT_artificial:
9761 case DW_AT_containing_type:
9762 case DW_AT_external:
9763 case DW_AT_name:
9764 case DW_AT_type:
9765 case DW_AT_virtuality:
9766 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
9767 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
9768 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9769 break;
9770 case DW_AT_byte_size:
9771 default:
9772 break;
9776 if (die->die_id.die_type_node)
9777 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
9779 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9780 return clone;
9783 /* Copy the declaration context to the new compile unit DIE. This includes
9784 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
9785 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
9786 attached to the specification. */
9788 static void
9789 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
9791 dw_die_ref decl;
9792 dw_die_ref new_decl;
9794 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9795 if (decl == NULL)
9796 decl = die;
9797 else
9799 unsigned ix;
9800 dw_die_ref c;
9801 dw_attr_ref a;
9803 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
9804 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
9805 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
9807 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
9809 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, decl->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9811 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
9812 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
9813 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
9814 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
9817 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree(c)));
9820 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
9821 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9822 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9824 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
9825 if (new_decl != NULL)
9827 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
9828 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
9833 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
9834 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
9836 static void
9837 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
9839 if (node->new_die != NULL)
9840 return;
9842 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
9844 if (node->parent != NULL)
9846 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
9847 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
9851 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
9852 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
9853 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
9855 static void
9856 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
9858 skeleton_chain_node node;
9859 dw_die_ref c;
9860 dw_die_ref first;
9861 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9862 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9864 node.parent = parent;
9866 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
9867 if (c)
9868 next = c->die_sib;
9869 if (c) do {
9870 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9871 prev = c;
9872 c = next;
9873 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9874 node.old_die = c;
9875 node.new_die = NULL;
9876 if (is_declaration_die (c))
9878 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
9879 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
9880 all the original's children, where the original came from. */
9881 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
9882 move_all_children (c, clone);
9884 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
9885 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
9886 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
9887 node.new_die = c;
9888 c = clone;
9890 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9891 } while (next != NULL);
9894 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
9896 static dw_die_ref
9897 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
9899 skeleton_chain_node node;
9901 node.old_die = die;
9902 node.new_die = NULL;
9903 node.parent = NULL;
9905 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
9906 always leave at least a declaration in its place. */
9907 if (die->die_parent != NULL && is_type_die (die->die_parent))
9908 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
9910 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9911 return node.new_die;
9914 /* Remove the DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
9915 declaration. The original DIE will be moved to a new compile unit
9916 so that existing references to it follow it to the new location. If
9917 any of the original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to
9918 replace the original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the
9919 declarations back into the skeleton tree. */
9921 static dw_die_ref
9922 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
9924 dw_die_ref skeleton;
9926 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
9927 if (skeleton == NULL)
9928 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
9929 else
9931 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
9932 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
9935 return skeleton;
9938 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
9939 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
9941 static void
9942 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
9944 dw_die_ref c;
9945 dw_die_ref first;
9946 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9947 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9948 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9950 first = c = die->die_child;
9951 if (c)
9952 next = c->die_sib;
9953 if (c) do {
9954 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9955 prev = c;
9956 c = next;
9957 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9958 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
9960 dw_die_ref replacement;
9961 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
9963 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
9964 add it to the list of comdat types. */
9965 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
9966 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
9967 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language));
9968 type_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_comdat_type_node ();
9969 type_node->root_die = unit;
9970 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
9971 comdat_type_list = type_node;
9973 /* Generate the type signature. */
9974 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
9976 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
9977 declaration into the new compile unit DIE. */
9978 copy_declaration_context (unit, c);
9980 /* Remove this DIE from the main CU. */
9981 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (c, prev);
9983 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
9984 break_out_comdat_types (c);
9986 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
9987 add_child_die (unit, c);
9989 if (replacement != NULL)
9990 c = replacement;
9992 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9993 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
9994 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
9995 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
9997 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
9998 break_out_comdat_types (c);
10000 } while (next != NULL);
10003 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
10005 struct decl_table_entry
10007 dw_die_ref orig;
10008 dw_die_ref copy;
10011 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
10013 static hashval_t
10014 htab_decl_hash (const void *of)
10016 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry =
10017 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of;
10019 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
10022 static int
10023 htab_decl_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
10025 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry1 =
10026 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of1;
10027 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
10029 return entry1->orig == entry2;
10032 static void
10033 htab_decl_del (void *what)
10035 struct decl_table_entry *entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) what;
10037 free (entry);
10040 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
10041 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
10042 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
10043 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
10045 static dw_die_ref
10046 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
10048 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
10049 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
10050 dw_die_ref copy;
10051 void **slot = NULL;
10052 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
10054 if (decl_table)
10056 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
10057 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
10058 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
10059 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
10061 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
10062 return entry->copy;
10065 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
10066 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
10067 entry->orig = die;
10068 entry->copy = NULL;
10069 *slot = entry;
10072 if (parent != NULL)
10074 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
10075 if (spec != NULL)
10076 parent = spec;
10077 if (parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10078 && parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10079 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
10082 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
10083 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
10085 if (decl_table != NULL)
10087 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
10088 entry->copy = copy;
10091 return copy;
10094 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
10095 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
10096 type_unit). */
10098 static void
10099 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
10101 dw_die_ref c;
10102 dw_attr_ref a;
10103 unsigned ix;
10105 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10107 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10109 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
10110 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = targ->die_id.die_type_node;
10111 void **slot;
10112 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
10114 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || type_node != NULL)
10115 continue;
10117 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, targ,
10118 htab_hash_pointer (targ), INSERT);
10120 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
10122 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
10123 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
10124 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
10125 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
10127 else
10129 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
10130 dw_die_ref copy = clone_tree (targ);
10132 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
10133 type unit. */
10134 mark_dies (copy);
10136 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
10137 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
10138 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
10139 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
10140 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
10141 entry->orig = targ;
10142 entry->copy = copy;
10143 *slot = entry;
10145 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
10146 into the new type unit. */
10147 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
10148 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10149 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10150 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
10151 decl_table);
10153 add_child_die (parent, copy);
10154 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
10156 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
10157 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
10158 get visited otherwise. */
10159 if (parent != unit)
10161 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
10162 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
10163 parent->die_mark = 1;
10164 while (parent->die_parent
10165 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
10167 parent = parent->die_parent;
10168 parent->die_mark = 1;
10170 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
10176 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
10179 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
10180 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
10181 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
10182 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
10183 don't have an external reference. */
10185 static void
10186 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
10188 htab_t decl_table;
10190 mark_dies (unit);
10191 decl_table = htab_create (10, htab_decl_hash, htab_decl_eq, htab_decl_del);
10192 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, decl_table);
10193 htab_delete (decl_table);
10194 unmark_dies (unit);
10197 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
10198 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
10199 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
10201 static void
10202 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
10204 dw_die_ref c;
10206 if (! die->die_child)
10207 return;
10209 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
10210 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
10212 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
10215 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
10217 static void
10218 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
10220 dw_die_ref c;
10221 dw_attr_ref a;
10222 unsigned ix;
10224 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10225 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
10226 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
10228 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
10231 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
10232 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
10233 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
10234 die are visited recursively. */
10236 static void
10237 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
10239 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10240 unsigned int n_alloc;
10241 dw_die_ref c;
10242 dw_attr_ref a;
10243 unsigned ix;
10245 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
10246 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
10247 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10248 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
10249 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
10251 gcc_assert (dwarf_version >= 4 || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
10252 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
10255 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10257 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10258 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
10259 unsigned ix;
10260 bool ok = true;
10262 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
10263 continue;
10264 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
10265 continue;
10267 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
10268 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
10269 continue;
10271 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
10273 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
10274 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
10275 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
10277 ok = false;
10278 break;
10281 if (ok)
10282 break;
10285 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
10287 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
10289 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10290 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
10291 n_alloc);
10293 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
10294 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
10295 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
10298 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
10299 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
10302 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
10303 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
10306 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
10308 static int
10309 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
10311 int log;
10313 if (value == 0)
10314 log = 0;
10315 else
10316 log = floor_log2 (value);
10318 log = log / 8;
10319 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
10321 return log;
10324 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
10325 .debug_info section. */
10327 static unsigned long
10328 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
10330 unsigned long size = 0;
10331 dw_attr_ref a;
10332 unsigned ix;
10334 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
10335 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10337 switch (AT_class (a))
10339 case dw_val_class_addr:
10340 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10341 break;
10342 case dw_val_class_offset:
10343 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10344 break;
10345 case dw_val_class_loc:
10347 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10349 /* Block length. */
10350 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10351 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
10352 else
10353 size += constant_size (lsize);
10354 size += lsize;
10356 break;
10357 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10358 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10359 break;
10360 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10361 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10362 break;
10363 case dw_val_class_const:
10364 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
10365 break;
10366 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10367 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10368 break;
10369 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10370 size += 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10371 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
10372 size++; /* block */
10373 break;
10374 case dw_val_class_vec:
10375 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10376 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
10377 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10378 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
10379 break;
10380 case dw_val_class_flag:
10381 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10382 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10383 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10384 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10385 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10386 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10387 the same abbrev entry. */
10388 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
10389 else
10390 size += 1;
10391 break;
10392 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10393 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10395 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_sig8; for earlier versions
10396 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
10397 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
10398 it's always sized as an offset. */
10399 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10400 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
10401 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
10402 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10403 else
10404 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10406 else
10407 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10408 break;
10409 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10410 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10411 break;
10412 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10413 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10414 break;
10415 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10416 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10417 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10418 break;
10419 case dw_val_class_str:
10420 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
10421 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10422 else
10423 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
10424 break;
10425 case dw_val_class_file:
10426 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
10427 break;
10428 case dw_val_class_data8:
10429 size += 8;
10430 break;
10431 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10432 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10433 break;
10434 default:
10435 gcc_unreachable ();
10439 return size;
10442 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
10443 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
10444 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
10445 die_offset field in each DIE. */
10447 static void
10448 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
10450 dw_die_ref c;
10452 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
10453 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
10455 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
10457 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10458 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
10459 next_die_offset += 1;
10462 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
10463 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
10464 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
10465 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
10467 static void
10468 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10470 dw_die_ref c;
10472 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
10474 die->die_mark = 1;
10475 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
10478 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
10480 static void
10481 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10483 dw_die_ref c;
10485 if (dwarf_version < 4)
10486 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
10488 die->die_mark = 0;
10489 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
10492 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
10494 static void
10495 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10497 dw_die_ref c;
10498 dw_attr_ref a;
10499 unsigned ix;
10501 if (!die->die_mark)
10502 return;
10503 die->die_mark = 0;
10505 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
10507 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10508 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10509 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
10512 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
10513 generated for the compilation unit. */
10515 static unsigned long
10516 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
10518 unsigned long size;
10519 unsigned i;
10520 pubname_ref p;
10522 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
10523 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
10524 if (names != pubtype_table
10525 || p->die->die_offset != 0
10526 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
10527 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
10529 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10530 return size;
10533 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
10535 static unsigned long
10536 size_of_aranges (void)
10538 unsigned long size;
10540 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
10542 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
10543 if (text_section_used)
10544 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10545 if (cold_text_section_used)
10546 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10547 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
10549 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
10550 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10551 return size;
10554 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
10556 static enum dwarf_form
10557 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10559 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
10561 case dw_val_class_addr:
10562 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
10563 switch (a->dw_attr)
10565 case DW_AT_low_pc:
10566 case DW_AT_high_pc:
10567 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
10568 case DW_AT_trampoline:
10569 return DW_FORM_addr;
10570 default:
10571 break;
10573 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10575 case 1:
10576 return DW_FORM_data1;
10577 case 2:
10578 return DW_FORM_data2;
10579 case 4:
10580 return DW_FORM_data4;
10581 case 8:
10582 return DW_FORM_data8;
10583 default:
10584 gcc_unreachable ();
10586 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10587 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10588 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10589 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
10590 /* FALLTHRU */
10591 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10592 case dw_val_class_offset:
10593 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
10595 case 4:
10596 return DW_FORM_data4;
10597 case 8:
10598 return DW_FORM_data8;
10599 default:
10600 gcc_unreachable ();
10602 case dw_val_class_loc:
10603 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10604 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
10605 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
10607 case 1:
10608 return DW_FORM_block1;
10609 case 2:
10610 return DW_FORM_block2;
10611 default:
10612 gcc_unreachable ();
10614 case dw_val_class_const:
10615 return DW_FORM_sdata;
10616 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10617 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
10619 case 1:
10620 return DW_FORM_data1;
10621 case 2:
10622 return DW_FORM_data2;
10623 case 4:
10624 return DW_FORM_data4;
10625 case 8:
10626 return DW_FORM_data8;
10627 default:
10628 gcc_unreachable ();
10630 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10631 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10633 case 8:
10634 return DW_FORM_data2;
10635 case 16:
10636 return DW_FORM_data4;
10637 case 32:
10638 return DW_FORM_data8;
10639 case 64:
10640 default:
10641 return DW_FORM_block1;
10643 case dw_val_class_vec:
10644 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10645 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
10647 case 1:
10648 return DW_FORM_block1;
10649 case 2:
10650 return DW_FORM_block2;
10651 case 4:
10652 return DW_FORM_block4;
10653 default:
10654 gcc_unreachable ();
10656 case dw_val_class_flag:
10657 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10659 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10660 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10661 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10662 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10663 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10664 the same abbrev entry. */
10665 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
10666 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
10668 return DW_FORM_flag;
10669 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10670 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10671 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
10672 else
10673 return DW_FORM_ref;
10674 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10675 return DW_FORM_data;
10676 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10677 return DW_FORM_addr;
10678 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10679 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10680 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
10681 case dw_val_class_str:
10682 return AT_string_form (a);
10683 case dw_val_class_file:
10684 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
10686 case 1:
10687 return DW_FORM_data1;
10688 case 2:
10689 return DW_FORM_data2;
10690 case 4:
10691 return DW_FORM_data4;
10692 default:
10693 gcc_unreachable ();
10696 case dw_val_class_data8:
10697 return DW_FORM_data8;
10699 default:
10700 gcc_unreachable ();
10704 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
10706 static void
10707 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10709 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
10711 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
10714 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
10715 table. */
10717 static void
10718 output_abbrev_section (void)
10720 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10722 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10724 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10725 unsigned ix;
10726 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
10728 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
10729 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
10730 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
10732 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
10733 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
10734 else
10735 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
10737 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
10738 ix++)
10740 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
10741 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
10742 output_value_format (a_attr);
10745 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10746 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10749 /* Terminate the table. */
10750 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10753 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
10755 static inline void
10756 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
10758 char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10760 if (sym == 0)
10761 return;
10763 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
10764 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
10765 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
10766 will break. */
10767 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
10769 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
10772 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
10773 expression. */
10775 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
10776 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
10777 const char *section)
10779 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_list_node ();
10781 retlist->begin = begin;
10782 retlist->end = end;
10783 retlist->expr = expr;
10784 retlist->section = section;
10786 return retlist;
10789 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
10790 hasn't got one yet. */
10792 static inline void
10793 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10795 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
10796 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
10799 /* Output the location list given to us. */
10801 static void
10802 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
10804 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
10806 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
10808 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
10809 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10811 unsigned long size;
10812 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
10813 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0)
10814 continue;
10815 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10817 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
10818 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10819 list_head->ll_symbol);
10820 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
10821 "Location list end address (%s)",
10822 list_head->ll_symbol);
10824 else
10826 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10827 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10828 list_head->ll_symbol);
10829 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10830 "Location list end address (%s)",
10831 list_head->ll_symbol);
10833 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
10835 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10836 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
10837 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
10839 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
10842 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10843 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
10844 list_head->ll_symbol);
10845 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10846 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
10847 list_head->ll_symbol);
10850 /* Output a type signature. */
10852 static inline void
10853 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
10855 int i;
10857 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10858 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10861 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
10862 the definitions of each child DIE. */
10864 static void
10865 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10867 dw_attr_ref a;
10868 dw_die_ref c;
10869 unsigned long size;
10870 unsigned ix;
10872 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
10873 them to point to. */
10874 if (dwarf_version < 4 && die->die_id.die_symbol)
10875 output_die_symbol (die);
10877 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
10878 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10879 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10881 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10883 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10885 switch (AT_class (a))
10887 case dw_val_class_addr:
10888 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
10889 break;
10891 case dw_val_class_offset:
10892 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10893 "%s", name);
10894 break;
10896 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10898 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
10900 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
10901 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
10902 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
10903 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10904 *p = '\0';
10906 break;
10908 case dw_val_class_loc:
10909 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10911 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10912 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10913 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10914 else
10915 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10917 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
10918 break;
10920 case dw_val_class_const:
10921 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10922 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10923 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10924 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10925 break;
10927 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10928 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
10929 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10930 break;
10932 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10934 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10936 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
10937 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10938 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10939 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10940 NULL);
10942 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10944 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10945 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10947 else
10949 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10950 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10953 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10954 first, name);
10955 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10956 second, NULL);
10958 break;
10960 case dw_val_class_vec:
10962 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10963 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10964 unsigned int i;
10965 unsigned char *p;
10967 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10968 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10969 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10971 elt_size /= 2;
10972 len *= 2;
10974 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10975 i < len;
10976 i++, p += elt_size)
10977 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10978 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10979 break;
10982 case dw_val_class_flag:
10983 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10985 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10986 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10987 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10988 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10989 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10990 the same abbrev entry. */
10991 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
10992 if (flag_debug_asm)
10993 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
10994 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
10995 break;
10997 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10998 break;
11000 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
11002 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
11004 gcc_assert (sym);
11005 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
11006 "%s", name);
11008 break;
11010 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
11011 if (AT_ref_external (a))
11013 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11015 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
11016 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
11018 gcc_assert (type_node);
11019 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
11021 else
11023 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
11024 int size;
11026 gcc_assert (sym);
11027 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
11028 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
11029 offset. */
11030 if (dwarf_version == 2)
11031 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11032 else
11033 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
11034 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
11035 name);
11038 else
11040 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
11041 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
11042 "%s", name);
11044 break;
11046 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
11048 char l1[20];
11050 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
11051 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
11052 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
11053 "%s", name);
11055 break;
11057 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
11058 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11059 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
11060 "%s", name);
11061 break;
11063 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
11064 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
11065 break;
11067 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
11068 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
11069 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
11070 break;
11072 case dw_val_class_macptr:
11073 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
11074 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
11075 break;
11077 case dw_val_class_str:
11078 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
11079 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11080 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
11081 debug_str_section,
11082 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
11083 else
11084 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
11085 break;
11087 case dw_val_class_file:
11089 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
11091 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
11092 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
11093 break;
11096 case dw_val_class_data8:
11098 int i;
11100 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11101 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
11102 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
11103 break;
11106 default:
11107 gcc_unreachable ();
11111 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
11113 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
11114 if (die->die_child != NULL)
11115 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
11116 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
11119 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
11120 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
11122 static void
11123 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
11125 int ver = dwarf_version;
11127 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11128 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11129 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11130 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11131 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
11132 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
11133 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
11134 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
11135 debug_abbrev_section,
11136 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
11137 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11140 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
11142 static void
11143 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
11145 const char *secname;
11146 char *oldsym, *tmp;
11148 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
11149 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
11150 return;
11152 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
11153 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
11154 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
11155 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
11156 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11157 mark_dies (die);
11159 build_abbrev_table (die);
11161 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11162 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11163 calc_die_sizes (die);
11165 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
11166 if (oldsym)
11168 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
11170 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
11171 secname = tmp;
11172 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
11173 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11175 else
11176 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
11178 /* Output debugging information. */
11179 output_compilation_unit_header ();
11180 output_die (die);
11182 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
11183 output_pubnames. */
11184 if (oldsym)
11186 unmark_dies (die);
11187 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
11191 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
11193 static void
11194 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
11196 const char *secname;
11197 char *tmp;
11198 int i;
11199 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11200 tree comdat_key;
11201 #endif
11203 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11204 mark_dies (node->root_die);
11206 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die);
11208 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11209 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11210 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
11212 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11213 secname = ".debug_types";
11214 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11215 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
11216 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11217 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11218 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
11219 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
11220 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
11221 comdat_key);
11222 #else
11223 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11224 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
11225 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11226 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11227 secname = tmp;
11228 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11229 #endif
11231 /* Output debugging information. */
11232 output_compilation_unit_header ();
11233 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
11234 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
11235 "Offset to Type DIE");
11236 output_die (node->root_die);
11238 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
11241 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
11243 static const char *
11244 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
11246 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
11249 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
11251 static void
11252 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
11254 if (targetm.want_debug_pub_sections)
11256 pubname_entry e;
11258 e.die = die;
11259 e.name = xstrdup (str);
11260 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
11264 static void
11265 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11267 if (targetm.want_debug_pub_sections && TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11269 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11270 if (name)
11271 add_pubname_string (name, die);
11275 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
11277 static void
11278 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11280 pubname_entry e;
11282 if (!targetm.want_debug_pub_sections)
11283 return;
11285 e.name = NULL;
11286 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11287 || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
11288 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
11290 e.die = die;
11291 if (TYPE_P (decl))
11293 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
11295 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11296 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
11297 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
11298 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
11299 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
11300 else
11301 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
11304 else
11306 e.name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11307 if (e.name)
11308 e.name = xstrdup (e.name);
11311 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
11312 it to the table. */
11313 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
11314 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
11318 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
11319 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
11321 static void
11322 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
11324 unsigned i;
11325 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
11326 pubname_ref pub;
11328 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11329 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11330 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11331 if (names == pubname_table)
11332 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11333 "Length of Public Names Info");
11334 else
11335 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11336 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
11337 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
11338 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
11339 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11340 debug_info_section,
11341 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11342 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
11343 "Compilation Unit Length");
11345 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
11347 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
11348 if (names == pubname_table)
11349 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
11351 if (names != pubtype_table
11352 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
11353 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
11355 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
11356 "DIE offset");
11358 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
11362 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11365 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
11367 static void
11368 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11370 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
11371 return;
11373 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
11375 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11376 arange_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, arange_table,
11377 arange_table_allocated);
11378 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
11379 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
11382 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
11385 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
11386 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
11387 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
11389 static void
11390 output_aranges (void)
11392 unsigned i;
11393 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
11395 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11396 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11397 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11398 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
11399 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
11400 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
11401 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
11402 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11403 debug_info_section,
11404 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11405 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
11406 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
11408 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
11409 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
11411 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
11412 pointer size. */
11413 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
11414 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11415 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
11416 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
11419 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
11420 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
11421 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
11422 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
11423 confused with the terminator. */
11424 if (text_section_used)
11426 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
11427 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
11428 text_section_label, "Length");
11430 if (cold_text_section_used)
11432 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
11433 "Address");
11434 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
11435 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
11438 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
11440 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
11442 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
11443 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
11445 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11447 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
11448 "Address");
11449 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
11450 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
11452 else
11454 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
11455 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
11456 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
11457 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
11458 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11460 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
11462 loc = AT_loc (a);
11463 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
11465 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11466 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
11467 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11468 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
11469 "Length");
11473 /* Output the terminator words. */
11474 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11475 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11478 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
11479 was placed. */
11481 static unsigned int
11482 add_ranges_num (int num)
11484 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
11486 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
11488 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11489 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
11490 ranges_table_allocated);
11491 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
11492 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
11495 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
11496 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
11498 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11501 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11502 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
11504 static unsigned int
11505 add_ranges (const_tree block)
11507 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
11510 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
11511 labels. */
11513 static void
11514 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11515 bool *added)
11517 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
11518 unsigned int offset;
11520 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
11522 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11523 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
11524 ranges_by_label,
11525 ranges_by_label_allocated);
11526 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
11527 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
11528 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
11531 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
11532 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
11533 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
11535 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
11536 if (!*added)
11538 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset);
11539 *added = true;
11543 static void
11544 output_ranges (void)
11546 unsigned i;
11547 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11548 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11550 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
11552 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
11554 if (block_num > 0)
11556 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11557 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11559 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11560 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11562 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11563 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11564 base of the text section. */
11565 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11567 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11568 text_section_label,
11569 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11570 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11571 text_section_label, NULL);
11574 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11575 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11576 about whether the target supports cross-section
11577 arithmetic. */
11578 else
11580 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11581 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11582 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11585 fmt = NULL;
11588 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11589 else if (block_num < 0)
11591 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11593 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11595 gcc_unreachable ();
11596 #if 0
11597 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11598 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11599 the #if 0 above. */
11600 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11601 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11602 text_section_label,
11603 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11604 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11605 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11606 text_section_label, NULL);
11607 #endif
11609 else
11611 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11612 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11613 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11614 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11615 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11616 NULL);
11619 else
11621 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11622 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11623 fmt = start_fmt;
11628 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11629 struct file_info
11631 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11632 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11633 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11634 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11635 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11638 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11639 files. */
11640 struct dir_info
11642 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11643 int length; /* Path length. */
11644 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11645 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11646 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11649 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11650 the directories in the path. */
11652 static int
11653 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11655 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11656 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11657 const unsigned char *cp1;
11658 const unsigned char *cp2;
11660 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11661 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11662 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11663 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11664 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11665 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11666 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11668 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11669 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11671 while (1)
11673 ++cp1;
11674 ++cp2;
11675 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11676 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11677 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11678 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11679 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11681 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11682 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11683 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11687 struct file_name_acquire_data
11689 struct file_info *files;
11690 int used_files;
11691 int max_files;
11694 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11696 static int
11697 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
11699 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = (struct file_name_acquire_data *) data;
11700 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
11701 struct file_info *fi;
11702 const char *f;
11704 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11706 if (! d->emitted_number)
11707 return 1;
11709 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11711 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11713 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11714 f = d->filename;
11715 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11716 f += 2;
11718 /* Create a new array entry. */
11719 fi->path = f;
11720 fi->length = strlen (f);
11721 fi->file_idx = d;
11723 /* Search for the file name part. */
11724 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11725 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11727 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11729 if (g != NULL)
11731 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11732 f = g;
11735 #endif
11737 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11738 return 1;
11741 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11742 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11743 slowdowns with many input files. */
11745 static void
11746 output_file_names (void)
11748 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11749 int numfiles;
11750 struct file_info *files;
11751 struct dir_info *dirs;
11752 int *saved;
11753 int *savehere;
11754 int *backmap;
11755 int ndirs;
11756 int idx_offset;
11757 int i;
11759 if (!last_emitted_file)
11761 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11762 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11763 return;
11766 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11768 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11769 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11770 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11772 fnad.files = files;
11773 fnad.used_files = 0;
11774 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11775 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
11776 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11778 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11780 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11781 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11782 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11783 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11784 dirs[0].count = 1;
11785 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11786 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11787 ndirs = 1;
11789 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11790 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11791 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11792 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11794 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11795 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11796 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11798 else
11800 int j;
11802 /* This is a new directory. */
11803 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11804 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11805 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11806 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11807 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11809 /* Search for a prefix. */
11810 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11811 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11812 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11813 && dirs[j].length > 1
11814 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11815 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11816 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11817 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11819 ++ndirs;
11822 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11823 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11824 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11825 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11826 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11827 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11828 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11829 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11831 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11832 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11834 int j;
11835 int total;
11837 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11838 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11839 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11840 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11842 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11844 savehere[j] = 0;
11845 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11847 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11848 dirs[j] path. */
11849 int k;
11851 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11852 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11853 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11855 if (k == (int) i)
11857 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11858 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11859 dirs[i]. */
11860 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11861 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11866 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11867 directory. */
11868 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11870 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11871 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11872 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11874 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11875 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11877 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11878 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11883 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11884 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11885 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11886 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11887 dirs[i].length
11888 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11889 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11891 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11893 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11894 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11895 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11896 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11897 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11898 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11900 /* Now write all the file names. */
11901 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11903 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11904 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11906 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11907 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11909 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11910 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11912 int ver;
11913 long long cdt;
11914 long siz;
11915 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11916 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11917 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
11918 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
11920 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
11921 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
11922 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
11924 dw2_asm_output_nstring
11925 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
11927 /* Include directory index. */
11928 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11930 /* Modification time. */
11931 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
11932 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
11933 ? cdt : 0,
11934 NULL);
11936 /* File length in bytes. */
11937 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
11938 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
11939 ? siz : 0,
11940 NULL);
11941 #else
11942 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
11943 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
11945 /* Include directory index. */
11946 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11948 /* Modification time. */
11949 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11951 /* File length in bytes. */
11952 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11953 #endif
11956 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11960 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
11961 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
11963 static void
11964 output_line_info (void)
11966 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
11967 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11968 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11969 unsigned opc;
11970 unsigned n_op_args;
11971 unsigned long lt_index;
11972 unsigned long current_line;
11973 long line_offset;
11974 long line_delta;
11975 unsigned long current_file;
11976 unsigned long function;
11977 int ver = dwarf_version;
11979 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
11980 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
11981 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
11982 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
11984 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11985 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11986 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11987 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11988 "Length of Source Line Info");
11989 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11991 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
11992 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
11993 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
11995 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
11996 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
11997 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
11998 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
11999 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
12000 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
12001 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
12002 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
12003 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
12004 "Minimum Instruction Length");
12006 if (ver >= 4)
12007 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12008 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12009 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12010 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12011 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12012 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12013 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12014 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12015 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12016 "Special Opcode Base");
12018 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12020 switch (opc)
12022 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12023 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12024 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12025 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12026 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12027 n_op_args = 1;
12028 break;
12029 default:
12030 n_op_args = 0;
12031 break;
12034 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12035 opc, n_op_args);
12038 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12039 output_file_names ();
12040 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12042 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
12043 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
12044 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
12046 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
12047 a series of state machine operations. */
12048 current_file = 1;
12049 current_line = 1;
12051 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
12052 strcpy (prev_line_label, crtl->subsections.cold_section_label);
12053 else
12054 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
12055 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
12057 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
12059 #if 0
12060 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
12061 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
12062 prologue. */
12064 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
12065 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
12066 that anything after the last address is this line. */
12067 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
12068 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
12069 continue;
12070 #endif
12072 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
12074 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
12075 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
12076 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
12077 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
12078 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
12079 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
12081 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
12082 if (0)
12084 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
12085 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12086 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12087 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12089 else
12091 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
12092 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
12093 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12094 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12095 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12096 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12099 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
12101 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
12102 different from the previous line. */
12103 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
12105 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
12106 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
12107 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
12110 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
12111 that uses the least amount of space. */
12112 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
12114 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
12115 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12116 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
12117 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12118 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
12119 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
12120 takes 1 byte. */
12121 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12122 "line %lu", current_line);
12123 else
12125 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
12126 depending on the value being encoded. */
12127 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12128 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
12129 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12130 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12133 else
12134 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
12135 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12138 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
12139 if (0)
12141 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12142 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12143 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12145 else
12147 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12148 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12149 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12150 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
12153 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
12154 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12155 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12157 function = 0;
12158 current_file = 1;
12159 current_line = 1;
12160 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
12162 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
12163 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
12165 #if 0
12166 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
12167 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
12168 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
12169 && line_info->function == function)
12170 goto cont;
12171 #endif
12173 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
12174 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
12175 to handle it differently. */
12176 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
12177 lt_index);
12178 if (function != line_info->function)
12180 function = line_info->function;
12182 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
12183 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12184 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12185 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12186 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12188 else
12190 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
12191 if (0)
12193 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12194 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12195 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12197 else
12199 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12200 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12201 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12202 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12206 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
12208 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
12209 different from the previous line. */
12210 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
12212 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
12213 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
12214 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
12217 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
12218 that uses the least amount of space. */
12219 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
12221 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
12222 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12223 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
12224 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12225 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12226 "line %lu", current_line);
12227 else
12229 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12230 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
12231 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12232 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12235 else
12236 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
12238 #if 0
12239 cont:
12240 #endif
12242 lt_index++;
12244 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
12245 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
12246 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
12248 current_file = 1;
12249 current_line = 1;
12251 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
12252 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
12253 if (0)
12255 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
12256 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
12257 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
12259 else
12261 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
12262 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12263 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12264 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12267 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
12268 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
12269 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12270 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12274 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12275 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12278 /* Return the size of the .debug_dcall table for the compilation unit. */
12280 static unsigned long
12281 size_of_dcall_table (void)
12283 unsigned long size;
12284 unsigned int i;
12285 dcall_entry *p;
12286 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
12288 /* Header: version + debug info section pointer + pointer size. */
12289 size = 2 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
12291 /* Each entry: code label + DIE offset. */
12292 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p); i++)
12294 gcc_assert (p->targ_die != NULL);
12295 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
12296 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
12298 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
12299 gcc_assert (poc_die);
12300 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
12301 if (poc_die)
12302 size += (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
12303 + size_of_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset));
12305 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset);
12308 return size;
12311 /* Output the direct call table used to disambiguate PC values when
12312 identical function have been merged. */
12314 static void
12315 output_dcall_table (void)
12317 unsigned i;
12318 unsigned long dcall_length = size_of_dcall_table ();
12319 dcall_entry *p;
12320 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12321 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
12323 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12324 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12325 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12326 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, dcall_length,
12327 "Length of Direct Call Table");
12328 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
12329 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
12330 debug_info_section,
12331 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
12332 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
12334 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p); i++)
12336 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
12337 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
12339 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
12340 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
12341 if (poc_die)
12343 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, "New caller");
12344 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset,
12345 "Caller DIE offset");
12348 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
12349 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
12350 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset,
12351 "Callee DIE offset");
12355 /* Return the size of the .debug_vcall table for the compilation unit. */
12357 static unsigned long
12358 size_of_vcall_table (void)
12360 unsigned long size;
12361 unsigned int i;
12362 vcall_entry *p;
12364 /* Header: version + pointer size. */
12365 size = 2 + 1;
12367 /* Each entry: code label + vtable slot index. */
12368 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p); i++)
12369 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot);
12371 return size;
12374 /* Output the virtual call table used to disambiguate PC values when
12375 identical function have been merged. */
12377 static void
12378 output_vcall_table (void)
12380 unsigned i;
12381 unsigned long vcall_length = size_of_vcall_table ();
12382 vcall_entry *p;
12383 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12385 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12386 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12387 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12388 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, vcall_length,
12389 "Length of Virtual Call Table");
12390 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
12391 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
12393 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p); i++)
12395 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
12396 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
12397 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot, "Vtable slot");
12401 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12402 a DIE that describes the given type.
12404 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12405 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12407 static dw_die_ref
12408 base_type_die (tree type)
12410 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12411 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12413 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
12414 return 0;
12416 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12417 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12418 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12419 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12421 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12423 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12424 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12425 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12426 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12427 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12428 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12430 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12431 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12432 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12434 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12435 break;
12438 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12440 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12441 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12442 else
12443 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12445 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12446 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12447 else
12448 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12449 break;
12451 case REAL_TYPE:
12452 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12454 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12455 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12456 else
12457 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12459 else
12460 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12461 break;
12463 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12464 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12465 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12466 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12467 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12468 else
12469 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12470 break;
12472 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12473 a user defined type for it. */
12474 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12475 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12476 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12477 else
12478 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12479 break;
12481 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12482 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12483 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12484 break;
12486 default:
12487 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12488 gcc_unreachable ();
12491 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12493 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12494 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12495 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12497 return base_type_result;
12500 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12501 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12503 static inline int
12504 is_base_type (tree type)
12506 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12508 case ERROR_MARK:
12509 case VOID_TYPE:
12510 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12511 case REAL_TYPE:
12512 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12513 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12514 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12515 return 1;
12517 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12518 case RECORD_TYPE:
12519 case UNION_TYPE:
12520 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12521 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12522 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12523 case METHOD_TYPE:
12524 case POINTER_TYPE:
12525 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12526 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12527 case LANG_TYPE:
12528 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12529 return 0;
12531 default:
12532 gcc_unreachable ();
12535 return 0;
12538 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12539 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12540 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12541 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12542 ERROR_MARK node. */
12544 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12545 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12547 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12548 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12549 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12550 return 0;
12551 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
12552 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
12553 else
12554 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12557 /* Similarly, but return a double_int instead of UHWI. */
12559 static inline double_int
12560 double_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12562 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12563 return uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_WORD);
12564 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12565 return double_int_zero;
12566 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12567 return tree_to_double_int (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12568 else
12569 return uhwi_to_double_int (TYPE_ALIGN (type));
12572 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12573 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12575 static dw_die_ref
12576 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
12578 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12579 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12581 if (context_die == NULL)
12582 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12584 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12586 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12588 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12589 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12590 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12593 if (low)
12594 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low);
12595 if (high)
12596 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high);
12598 return subrange_die;
12601 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12602 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
12604 static dw_die_ref
12605 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
12606 dw_die_ref context_die)
12608 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12609 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12610 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12611 tree item_type = NULL;
12612 tree qualified_type;
12613 tree name, low, high;
12615 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12616 return NULL;
12618 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12619 this type. */
12620 qualified_type
12621 = get_qualified_type (type,
12622 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
12623 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
12625 if (qualified_type == sizetype
12626 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
12627 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
12629 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
12630 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
12631 == INTEGER_TYPE
12632 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
12633 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
12634 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
12635 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
12636 #endif
12637 qualified_type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
12640 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12641 if (qualified_type)
12643 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12644 if (mod_type_die)
12645 return mod_type_die;
12648 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12650 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12651 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
12652 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
12654 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12656 if (qualified_type == dtype)
12658 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12659 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12660 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12662 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12663 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12664 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12665 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12666 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12667 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
12668 type to which it refers. */
12669 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
12670 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
12671 context_die);
12672 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12675 if (is_const_type)
12677 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12678 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
12680 else if (is_volatile_type)
12682 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12683 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
12685 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
12687 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12688 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12689 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12690 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12691 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12692 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12693 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12695 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12697 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
12698 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, comp_unit_die,
12699 type);
12700 else
12701 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12702 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12703 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12704 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12705 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12706 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12707 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12709 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12710 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12711 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12713 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
12714 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12716 else if (is_base_type (type))
12717 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
12718 else
12720 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12722 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12723 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12724 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12725 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12726 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12727 ..._TYPE node. */
12728 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12729 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12730 else
12731 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12732 not the main variant. */
12733 return lookup_type_die (type);
12736 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12737 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12738 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12739 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12740 if the base type already has the same name. */
12741 if (name
12742 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12743 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12744 || (!is_const_type && !is_volatile_type)))
12745 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12746 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12747 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12749 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12750 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12751 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12752 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12753 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12754 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12756 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
12757 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
12758 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, "__unknown__");
12760 if (qualified_type)
12761 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12763 if (item_type)
12764 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12765 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12766 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12767 types are possible in Ada. */
12768 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12769 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
12770 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
12771 context_die);
12773 if (sub_die != NULL)
12774 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12776 return mod_type_die;
12779 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12780 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12781 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12783 static void
12784 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12786 tree parms, args;
12787 int parms_num, i;
12788 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12790 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12791 return;
12793 if (TYPE_P (t))
12794 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12795 else if (DECL_P (t))
12796 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12798 gcc_assert (die);
12800 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12801 if (!parms)
12802 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12803 or function. End of story. */
12804 return;
12806 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12807 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12808 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12810 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12812 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12813 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12814 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12815 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12817 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12819 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12820 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12821 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12822 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12823 an argument pack. */
12824 if (arg_pack_elems)
12825 template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12826 arg_pack_elems,
12827 die);
12828 else
12829 generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12830 true /* Emit DW_AT_name */, die);
12835 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12836 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12837 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12838 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12839 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12840 name of the PARM.
12841 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12842 as a child node. */
12844 static dw_die_ref
12845 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12846 bool emit_name_p,
12847 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12849 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12850 const char *name = NULL;
12852 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12853 return NULL;
12855 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12856 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12857 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12858 and arguments. */
12859 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12860 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12861 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12862 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12863 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12864 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12865 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12866 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12867 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12868 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12869 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12870 name of the template template argument. */
12871 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12872 parent_die, parm);
12873 else
12874 gcc_unreachable ();
12876 if (tmpl_die)
12878 tree tmpl_type;
12880 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12881 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12882 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12883 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12884 the die. */
12885 if (emit_name_p)
12887 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12888 gcc_assert (name);
12889 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12892 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12894 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12895 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12896 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12897 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12898 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12899 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12900 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type, 0,
12901 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type),
12902 parent_die);
12904 else
12906 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12907 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12908 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12910 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12911 to the name of the argument. */
12912 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12913 if (name)
12914 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12917 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12918 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
12919 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
12920 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
12921 of ARG.
12922 We must be careful here:
12923 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
12924 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
12925 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
12926 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
12927 emitted after cgraph computations.
12928 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
12929 after cgraph is ready. */
12930 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
12933 return tmpl_die;
12936 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
12937 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
12938 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
12940 static dw_die_ref
12941 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
12942 tree parm_pack_args,
12943 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12945 dw_die_ref die;
12946 int j;
12948 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
12950 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
12951 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
12952 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
12953 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
12954 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
12955 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
12956 die);
12957 return die;
12960 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
12961 an enumerated type. */
12963 static inline int
12964 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
12966 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
12969 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
12971 static unsigned int
12972 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
12974 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
12976 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
12978 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12979 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
12981 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
12982 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12983 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12985 #endif
12987 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
12990 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
12991 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
12992 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
12994 static void
12995 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
12997 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
12999 if (*list_head != NULL)
13001 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13002 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13005 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13006 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13010 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13011 zero if there is none. */
13013 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13014 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13016 rtx regs;
13018 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13019 return 0;
13021 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13022 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13023 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13024 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13025 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13026 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13027 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13029 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13031 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13033 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode, initialized);
13034 if (result)
13035 add_loc_descr (&result,
13036 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13038 return result;
13041 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13043 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
13044 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13045 else
13046 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
13049 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13050 a given hard register number. */
13052 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13053 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13055 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13057 if (regno <= 31)
13058 reg_loc_descr
13059 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13060 else
13061 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13063 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13064 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13066 return reg_loc_descr;
13069 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13070 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13072 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13073 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13074 enum var_init_status initialized)
13076 int nregs, size, i;
13077 unsigned reg;
13078 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13080 reg = REGNO (rtl);
13081 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13082 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
13084 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13085 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13086 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13088 #endif
13089 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13090 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
13092 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13093 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13095 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
13097 loc_result = NULL;
13098 while (nregs--)
13100 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13102 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13103 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13104 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13105 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13106 ++reg;
13108 return loc_result;
13111 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13113 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13115 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13116 loc_result = NULL;
13118 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13120 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13122 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13123 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13124 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13125 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13126 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13129 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13130 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13131 return loc_result;
13134 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
13136 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
13138 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
13140 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13141 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13143 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13145 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13146 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13147 if (i >= 0)
13149 if (i <= 31)
13150 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13151 else if (i <= 0xff)
13152 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13153 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13154 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13155 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13156 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13157 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13158 else
13159 op = DW_OP_constu;
13161 else
13163 if (i >= -0x80)
13164 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13165 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13166 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13167 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13168 || i >= -0x80000000)
13169 op = DW_OP_const4s;
13170 else
13171 op = DW_OP_consts;
13174 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
13176 #endif
13178 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
13179 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
13180 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
13182 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13183 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13185 int litsize;
13186 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13188 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13189 return NULL;
13191 if (i >= 0)
13193 if (i <= 31)
13194 litsize = 1;
13195 else if (i <= 0xff)
13196 litsize = 2;
13197 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13198 litsize = 3;
13199 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13200 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13201 litsize = 5;
13202 else
13203 litsize = 1 + size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13205 else
13207 if (i >= -0x80)
13208 litsize = 2;
13209 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13210 litsize = 3;
13211 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13212 || i >= -0x80000000)
13213 litsize = 5;
13214 else
13215 litsize = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
13217 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
13218 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
13219 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
13220 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
13221 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
13222 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
13224 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
13225 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13226 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13227 return loc_result;
13230 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13231 size, 0);
13232 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13233 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
13234 return loc_result;
13237 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
13239 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13240 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
13241 enum var_init_status initialized)
13243 unsigned int regno;
13244 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
13245 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
13247 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13248 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13249 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13250 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
13251 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13253 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
13255 if (elim != reg)
13257 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
13259 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
13260 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
13262 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
13263 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13264 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
13265 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
13266 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13267 : stack_pointer_rtx));
13269 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
13270 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
13271 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
13272 access stack variables. */
13273 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
13274 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13276 int base_reg
13277 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
13278 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
13279 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
13280 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
13283 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
13284 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13287 else if (!optimize
13288 && fde
13289 && (fde->drap_reg == REGNO (reg)
13290 || fde->vdrap_reg == REGNO (reg)))
13292 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
13293 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
13294 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
13295 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
13296 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
13297 else in other part of the routine. */
13298 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13301 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
13302 if (regno <= 31)
13303 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
13304 offset, 0);
13305 else
13306 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
13308 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13309 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13311 return result;
13314 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
13316 static inline int
13317 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
13319 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
13320 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13321 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
13322 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
13325 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
13326 failed. */
13328 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13329 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
13331 tree base;
13332 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
13334 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || MEM_OFFSET (mem) == NULL_RTX)
13335 return NULL;
13337 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
13338 if (base == NULL
13339 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
13340 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
13341 return NULL;
13343 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1);
13344 if (loc_result == NULL)
13345 return NULL;
13347 if (INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)))
13348 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)));
13350 return loc_result;
13353 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
13354 expression. */
13356 static void
13357 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
13359 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
13361 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
13362 if (expr)
13363 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
13364 if (rtl)
13366 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
13367 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
13369 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
13373 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output, called either directly
13374 or via for_each_rtx. */
13376 static int
13377 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx *rtlp, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13379 rtx rtl = *rtlp;
13381 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
13383 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
13384 we can't express it in the debug info. */
13385 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13386 inform (current_function_decl
13387 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
13388 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
13389 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
13390 XINT (rtl, 1));
13391 #endif
13392 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13393 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
13394 return 1;
13397 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
13398 return 0;
13400 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13402 bool marked;
13403 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13404 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13405 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
13406 if (!marked)
13408 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13409 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13410 return 1;
13414 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13415 return 1;
13417 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
13418 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
13419 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
13420 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
13421 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
13422 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
13424 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
13426 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
13428 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13429 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
13430 return 1;
13434 return 0;
13437 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
13438 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
13439 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
13441 static bool
13442 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
13444 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
13445 return const_ok_for_output_1 (&rtl, NULL) == 0;
13447 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13448 return for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), const_ok_for_output_1, NULL) == 0;
13450 return true;
13453 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
13454 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
13455 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
13456 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
13458 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
13459 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
13460 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
13461 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
13463 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
13464 autoincrement addressing modes.
13466 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
13467 location list for RTL.
13469 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
13471 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13472 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
13473 enum var_init_status initialized)
13475 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
13476 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13477 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
13479 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
13480 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
13481 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
13482 zeroth element of the array. */
13484 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
13486 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13488 case POST_INC:
13489 case POST_DEC:
13490 case POST_MODIFY:
13491 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13493 case SUBREG:
13494 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13495 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13496 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13497 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13498 contains the given subreg. */
13499 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
13500 break;
13501 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
13502 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13503 break;
13504 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (rtl)) != MODE_INT)
13505 break;
13506 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, initialized);
13507 break;
13509 case REG:
13510 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
13511 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
13512 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
13513 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
13514 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
13515 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
13516 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
13517 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
13518 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
13519 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
13520 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
13521 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
13522 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
13523 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13524 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13525 else if (stack_realign_drap
13526 && crtl->drap_reg
13527 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
13528 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13530 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
13531 out, use DRAP instead. */
13532 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
13533 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13535 break;
13537 case SIGN_EXTEND:
13538 case ZERO_EXTEND:
13539 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13540 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13541 if (op0 == 0)
13542 break;
13543 else
13545 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13546 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13547 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13548 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
13549 op = DW_OP_shra;
13550 else
13551 op = DW_OP_shr;
13552 mem_loc_result = op0;
13553 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13554 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13555 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13556 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13558 break;
13560 case MEM:
13561 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
13562 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13563 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
13564 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13565 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
13567 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13569 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl, "DWARF address size mismatch");
13570 return 0;
13572 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13573 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
13574 else
13575 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13576 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
13577 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)), 0));
13579 else
13581 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
13582 if (new_rtl != rtl)
13583 return mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
13585 break;
13587 case LO_SUM:
13588 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13590 /* ... fall through ... */
13592 case LABEL_REF:
13593 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
13594 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
13595 pool. */
13596 case CONST:
13597 case SYMBOL_REF:
13598 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
13599 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13601 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13603 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
13604 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13605 break;
13607 /* We used to emit DW_OP_addr here, but that's wrong, since
13608 DW_OP_addr should be relocated by the debug info consumer,
13609 while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address operand should not. */
13610 temp = new_loc_descr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4
13611 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u, 0, 0);
13612 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13613 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13614 temp->dtprel = true;
13616 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
13617 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
13619 break;
13622 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13623 break;
13625 symref:
13626 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13627 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13628 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13629 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
13630 break;
13632 case CONCAT:
13633 case CONCATN:
13634 case VAR_LOCATION:
13635 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13636 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
13637 return 0;
13639 case PRE_MODIFY:
13640 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
13641 PLUS code below. */
13642 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13643 goto plus;
13645 case PRE_INC:
13646 case PRE_DEC:
13647 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
13648 below. */
13649 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
13650 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
13651 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
13652 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
13654 /* ... fall through ... */
13656 case PLUS:
13657 plus:
13658 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
13659 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13660 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
13661 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13662 else
13664 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13665 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13666 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
13667 break;
13669 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13670 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13671 else
13673 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result2
13674 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13675 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13676 if (mem_loc_result2 == 0)
13677 break;
13678 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, mem_loc_result2);
13679 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13680 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13683 break;
13685 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
13686 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
13687 case MINUS:
13688 op = DW_OP_minus;
13689 goto do_binop;
13691 case MULT:
13692 op = DW_OP_mul;
13693 goto do_binop;
13695 case DIV:
13696 op = DW_OP_div;
13697 goto do_binop;
13699 case UMOD:
13700 op = DW_OP_mod;
13701 goto do_binop;
13703 case ASHIFT:
13704 op = DW_OP_shl;
13705 goto do_binop;
13707 case ASHIFTRT:
13708 op = DW_OP_shra;
13709 goto do_binop;
13711 case LSHIFTRT:
13712 op = DW_OP_shr;
13713 goto do_binop;
13715 case AND:
13716 op = DW_OP_and;
13717 goto do_binop;
13719 case IOR:
13720 op = DW_OP_or;
13721 goto do_binop;
13723 case XOR:
13724 op = DW_OP_xor;
13725 goto do_binop;
13727 do_binop:
13728 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13729 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13730 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13731 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13733 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13734 break;
13736 mem_loc_result = op0;
13737 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13738 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13739 break;
13741 case MOD:
13742 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13743 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13744 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13745 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13747 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13748 break;
13750 mem_loc_result = op0;
13751 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13752 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13753 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13754 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
13755 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13756 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13757 break;
13759 case NOT:
13760 op = DW_OP_not;
13761 goto do_unop;
13763 case ABS:
13764 op = DW_OP_abs;
13765 goto do_unop;
13767 case NEG:
13768 op = DW_OP_neg;
13769 goto do_unop;
13771 do_unop:
13772 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13773 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13775 if (op0 == 0)
13776 break;
13778 mem_loc_result = op0;
13779 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13780 break;
13782 case CONST_INT:
13783 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13784 break;
13786 case EQ:
13787 op = DW_OP_eq;
13788 goto do_scompare;
13790 case GE:
13791 op = DW_OP_ge;
13792 goto do_scompare;
13794 case GT:
13795 op = DW_OP_gt;
13796 goto do_scompare;
13798 case LE:
13799 op = DW_OP_le;
13800 goto do_scompare;
13802 case LT:
13803 op = DW_OP_lt;
13804 goto do_scompare;
13806 case NE:
13807 op = DW_OP_ne;
13808 goto do_scompare;
13810 do_scompare:
13811 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13812 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13813 break;
13814 else
13816 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13818 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13819 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13820 if (op_mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
13821 break;
13823 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13824 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13825 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13826 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13828 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13829 break;
13831 if (op_mode != VOIDmode
13832 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13834 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode);
13835 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13836 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
13837 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
13838 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
13840 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13841 for (last0 = op0;
13842 last0->dw_loc_next != NULL;
13843 last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13845 for (last1 = op1;
13846 last1->dw_loc_next != NULL;
13847 last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13849 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
13850 whether they are zero extended or not. */
13851 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13852 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
13853 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13854 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13855 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13856 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13857 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13858 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13859 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
13860 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13861 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13862 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
13863 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13864 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13865 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
13866 goto do_compare;
13868 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13869 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13870 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13871 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
13872 else
13874 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13875 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13880 do_compare:
13881 mem_loc_result = op0;
13882 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13883 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13884 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13886 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13887 int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13888 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13890 break;
13892 case GEU:
13893 op = DW_OP_ge;
13894 goto do_ucompare;
13896 case GTU:
13897 op = DW_OP_gt;
13898 goto do_ucompare;
13900 case LEU:
13901 op = DW_OP_le;
13902 goto do_ucompare;
13904 case LTU:
13905 op = DW_OP_lt;
13906 goto do_ucompare;
13908 do_ucompare:
13909 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13910 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13911 break;
13912 else
13914 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13916 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13917 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13918 if (op_mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
13919 break;
13921 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13922 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13923 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13924 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13926 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13927 break;
13929 if (op_mode != VOIDmode
13930 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13932 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
13933 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13934 for (last0 = op0;
13935 last0->dw_loc_next != NULL;
13936 last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13938 for (last1 = op1;
13939 last1->dw_loc_next != NULL;
13940 last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13942 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13943 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
13944 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
13945 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
13946 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
13947 > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13949 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13950 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13952 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13953 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
13954 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
13955 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
13956 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int
13957 > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13959 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13960 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13963 else
13965 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
13966 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
13967 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13968 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13969 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
13970 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13971 else
13972 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
13973 bias, 0));
13976 goto do_compare;
13978 case SMIN:
13979 case SMAX:
13980 case UMIN:
13981 case UMAX:
13982 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13983 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13984 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13985 break;
13987 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13988 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13989 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13990 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13992 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13993 break;
13995 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
13996 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13997 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13998 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14000 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14002 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
14003 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14004 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14005 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14006 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14008 else
14010 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14011 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14012 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14013 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14016 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14018 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14019 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
14020 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
14021 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14022 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14023 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14024 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14027 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14028 op = DW_OP_lt;
14029 else
14030 op = DW_OP_gt;
14031 mem_loc_result = op0;
14032 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
14033 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14035 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14037 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14038 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
14039 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14040 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14041 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
14042 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14043 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14045 break;
14047 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
14048 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
14049 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14050 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
14051 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14052 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
14053 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)))
14054 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14055 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14057 int shift, size;
14058 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
14059 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14060 if (op0 == 0)
14061 break;
14062 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
14063 op = DW_OP_shra;
14064 else
14065 op = DW_OP_shr;
14066 mem_loc_result = op0;
14067 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14068 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
14069 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14070 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14071 - shift - size;
14072 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14074 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14075 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14076 - shift - size));
14077 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14079 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14081 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14082 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
14083 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14086 break;
14088 case COMPARE:
14089 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
14090 case ROTATE:
14091 case ROTATERT:
14092 case TRUNCATE:
14093 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
14094 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
14095 natively. */
14096 case SS_MULT:
14097 case US_MULT:
14098 case SS_DIV:
14099 case US_DIV:
14100 case SS_PLUS:
14101 case US_PLUS:
14102 case SS_MINUS:
14103 case US_MINUS:
14104 case SS_NEG:
14105 case US_NEG:
14106 case SS_ABS:
14107 case SS_ASHIFT:
14108 case US_ASHIFT:
14109 case SS_TRUNCATE:
14110 case US_TRUNCATE:
14111 case UDIV:
14112 case UNORDERED:
14113 case ORDERED:
14114 case UNEQ:
14115 case UNGE:
14116 case UNGT:
14117 case UNLE:
14118 case UNLT:
14119 case LTGT:
14120 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
14121 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
14122 case FLOAT:
14123 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
14124 case FIX:
14125 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
14126 case FRACT_CONVERT:
14127 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
14128 case SAT_FRACT:
14129 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
14130 case SQRT:
14131 case BSWAP:
14132 case FFS:
14133 case CLZ:
14134 case CTZ:
14135 case POPCOUNT:
14136 case PARITY:
14137 case ASM_OPERANDS:
14138 case VEC_MERGE:
14139 case VEC_SELECT:
14140 case VEC_CONCAT:
14141 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
14142 case UNSPEC:
14143 case HIGH:
14144 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
14145 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
14146 TLS UNSPECs. */
14147 break;
14149 case CONST_STRING:
14150 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
14151 goto symref;
14153 default:
14154 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
14155 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
14156 gcc_unreachable ();
14157 #else
14158 break;
14159 #endif
14162 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14163 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14165 return mem_loc_result;
14168 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
14169 This is typically a complex variable. */
14171 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14172 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
14174 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14175 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
14176 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14177 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
14178 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14180 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
14181 return 0;
14183 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
14184 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
14186 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
14187 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
14189 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14190 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14192 return cc_loc_result;
14195 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
14196 locations. */
14198 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14199 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
14201 unsigned int i;
14202 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14203 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
14205 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
14207 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
14208 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
14210 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14211 if (ref == NULL)
14212 return NULL;
14214 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
14215 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
14218 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14219 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14221 return cc_loc_result;
14224 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
14225 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
14226 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
14227 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
14228 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
14230 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
14231 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
14232 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
14234 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
14236 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14237 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14238 enum var_init_status initialized)
14240 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
14242 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14244 case SUBREG:
14245 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14246 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14247 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14248 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14249 contains the given subreg. */
14250 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl), mode, initialized);
14251 break;
14253 case REG:
14254 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14255 break;
14257 case MEM:
14258 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
14259 initialized);
14260 if (loc_result == NULL)
14261 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14262 if (loc_result == NULL)
14264 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14265 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14266 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
14268 break;
14270 case CONCAT:
14271 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
14272 initialized);
14273 break;
14275 case CONCATN:
14276 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14277 break;
14279 case VAR_LOCATION:
14280 /* Single part. */
14281 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
14283 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
14284 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14285 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
14286 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
14287 break;
14290 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14291 /* FALLTHRU */
14293 case PARALLEL:
14295 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
14296 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
14297 enum machine_mode mode;
14298 int i;
14300 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
14301 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
14302 VOIDmode, initialized);
14303 if (loc_result == NULL)
14304 return NULL;
14305 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
14306 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14307 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
14309 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14311 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
14312 VOIDmode, initialized);
14313 if (temp == NULL)
14314 return NULL;
14315 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
14316 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
14317 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14320 break;
14322 case CONST_INT:
14323 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
14324 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
14325 INTVAL (rtl));
14326 break;
14328 case CONST_DOUBLE:
14329 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14330 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14332 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14334 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14336 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
14337 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
14338 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
14339 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
14340 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14341 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14342 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
14344 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
14345 unsigned char *array
14346 = (unsigned char*) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
14348 insert_float (rtl, array);
14349 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14350 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
14351 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
14352 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14354 else
14356 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
14357 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
14358 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
14361 break;
14363 case CONST_VECTOR:
14364 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14365 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14367 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14369 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
14370 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
14371 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
14372 ggc_alloc_atomic (length * elt_size);
14373 unsigned int i;
14374 unsigned char *p;
14376 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14377 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
14379 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
14380 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14382 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14383 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
14385 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
14386 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
14387 else
14389 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
14390 insert_double (val, p);
14393 break;
14395 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
14396 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14398 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14399 insert_float (elt, p);
14401 break;
14403 default:
14404 gcc_unreachable ();
14407 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14408 length * elt_size, 0);
14409 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14410 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
14411 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
14412 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14414 break;
14416 case CONST:
14417 if (mode == VOIDmode
14418 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_INT
14419 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
14420 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
14422 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
14423 break;
14425 /* FALLTHROUGH */
14426 case SYMBOL_REF:
14427 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14428 break;
14429 case LABEL_REF:
14430 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14431 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14433 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
14434 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14435 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14436 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14437 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
14439 break;
14441 default:
14442 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
14443 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14444 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14446 /* Value expression. */
14447 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode, initialized);
14448 if (loc_result)
14449 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
14450 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14452 break;
14455 return loc_result;
14458 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
14459 address ranges where a given location is valid.
14460 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
14461 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
14462 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
14463 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
14465 static const char *
14466 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
14468 const char *secname;
14470 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
14472 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
14473 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
14475 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
14477 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
14478 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
14480 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
14481 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
14482 else
14483 secname = text_section_label;
14485 return secname;
14488 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
14490 static bool
14491 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
14493 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
14494 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
14495 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
14498 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14499 for VARLOC. */
14501 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14502 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
14503 enum var_init_status initialized)
14505 int have_address = 0;
14506 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14507 enum machine_mode mode;
14509 if (want_address != 2)
14511 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
14512 /* Single part. */
14513 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14515 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14516 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14517 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14518 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
14519 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14521 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14522 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, mode, initialized);
14523 if (descr)
14524 have_address = 1;
14525 else
14527 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
14528 if (x != varloc)
14529 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, initialized);
14532 else
14533 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
14535 else
14536 return 0;
14538 else
14540 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
14541 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
14542 else
14543 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
14544 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
14545 have_address = 1;
14548 if (!descr)
14549 return 0;
14551 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14552 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14554 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14556 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14557 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14558 return 0;
14560 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14561 have_address = 1;
14563 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14564 if (want_address && !have_address)
14566 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14567 "Want address and only have value");
14568 return 0;
14571 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
14572 if (!want_address && have_address)
14574 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14575 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14577 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
14579 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14580 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14581 return 0;
14583 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14584 op = DW_OP_deref;
14585 else
14586 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
14588 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14591 return descr;
14594 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
14595 if it is not possible. */
14597 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14598 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14600 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
14601 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
14602 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
14603 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
14604 else
14605 return NULL;
14608 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14609 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
14611 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14612 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
14614 rtx p;
14615 unsigned int padsize = 0;
14616 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
14617 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
14618 rtx varloc;
14619 enum var_init_status initialized;
14621 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
14622 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
14623 return NULL;
14625 decl_size = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1);
14626 descr = NULL;
14627 descr_tail = &descr;
14629 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
14631 unsigned int bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
14632 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
14633 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
14634 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
14635 unsigned int opsize = 0;
14637 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
14638 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
14640 padsize += bitsize;
14641 continue;
14643 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
14644 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
14645 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
14646 if (cur_descr == NULL)
14648 padsize += bitsize;
14649 continue;
14652 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
14653 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
14654 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
14655 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
14656 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
14657 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
14659 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
14660 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14661 last = *tail;
14663 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
14665 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
14666 last = *tail;
14669 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
14671 padsize += bitsize;
14672 continue;
14675 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
14676 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
14677 if (padsize)
14679 if (padsize > decl_size)
14680 return NULL;
14681 decl_size -= padsize;
14682 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
14683 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14684 return NULL;
14685 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14686 padsize = 0;
14688 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
14689 descr_tail = tail;
14690 if (bitsize > decl_size)
14691 return NULL;
14692 decl_size -= bitsize;
14693 if (last == NULL)
14695 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
14696 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
14697 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14699 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14700 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14701 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14705 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
14706 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
14707 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
14708 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14709 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
14710 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
14711 else
14712 break;
14714 while (1);
14715 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
14716 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
14717 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
14718 adjustment. */
14719 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14721 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
14722 = INTVAL (MEM_SIZE (varloc)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14723 if (memsize != bitsize)
14725 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
14726 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
14727 return NULL;
14728 if (memsize < bitsize)
14729 return NULL;
14730 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14731 offset = memsize - bitsize;
14735 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
14736 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14737 return NULL;
14738 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14742 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
14743 the decl. */
14744 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
14746 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
14747 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14748 return NULL;
14750 return descr;
14753 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
14754 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
14755 function. */
14757 static dw_loc_list_ref
14758 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
14760 const char *endname, *secname;
14761 rtx varloc;
14762 enum var_init_status initialized;
14763 struct var_loc_node *node;
14764 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14765 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
14766 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
14767 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
14769 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
14770 actually construct the list of locations.
14771 The first location information is what is passed to the
14772 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
14773 locations just get added on to that list.
14774 Note that we only know the start address for a location
14775 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
14776 the range [current location start, next location start].
14777 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
14778 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
14780 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
14782 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
14783 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
14784 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
14786 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14788 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
14789 inside DWARF expressions. */
14790 if (want_address != 2)
14791 continue;
14792 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14793 if (descr == NULL)
14794 continue;
14796 else
14798 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14799 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14800 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14802 if (descr)
14804 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14805 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14806 if (node->next)
14807 endname = node->next->label;
14808 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
14809 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
14810 else if (!current_function_decl)
14811 endname = text_end_label;
14812 else
14814 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
14815 current_function_funcdef_no);
14816 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14819 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14820 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14824 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
14825 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
14826 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
14827 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
14828 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
14829 available. */
14830 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
14831 gen_llsym (list);
14833 return list;
14836 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
14837 as location description. */
14839 static bool
14840 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
14842 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
14843 return !list->ll_symbol;
14846 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
14848 static void
14849 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
14851 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
14852 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
14853 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14854 while (list)
14856 copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
14857 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14858 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
14859 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
14861 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
14862 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14863 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
14864 copy = new_copy;
14866 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14870 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
14871 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
14872 to expression in RET on each possition in program.
14873 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
14875 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
14876 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
14877 and merging them that will need some additional work.
14878 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
14879 structures. */
14881 static void
14882 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
14884 if (!list)
14885 return;
14886 if (!*ret)
14888 *ret = list;
14889 return;
14891 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
14893 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
14894 return;
14896 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
14898 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
14899 *ret = list;
14900 return;
14902 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
14903 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
14904 " location lists.\n");
14905 *ret = NULL;
14906 return;
14909 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
14910 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
14912 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14913 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
14915 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
14916 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
14917 enum machine_mode mode;
14919 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
14921 gcc_assert (!rtl);
14922 return 0;
14924 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
14926 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
14927 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
14928 populated. */
14929 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
14931 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14932 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
14933 return 0;
14935 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14936 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14937 return mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14940 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
14941 by looking for innder INDIRECT_REF expression and turing it
14942 into simple arithmetics. */
14944 static dw_loc_list_ref
14945 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev)
14947 tree obj, offset;
14948 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14949 enum machine_mode mode;
14950 int volatilep;
14951 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14952 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14954 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
14955 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14956 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14957 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
14958 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
14960 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
14961 return 0;
14963 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
14965 expansion_failed (obj,
14966 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
14967 return 0;
14969 if (!offset && !bitpos)
14970 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1);
14971 else if (toplev
14972 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14973 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14975 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0);
14976 if (!list_ret)
14977 return 0;
14978 if (offset)
14980 /* Variable offset. */
14981 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
14982 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14983 return 0;
14984 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14985 if (!list_ret)
14986 return 0;
14987 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14988 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14990 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14991 if (bytepos > 0)
14992 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14993 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14994 bytepos, 0));
14995 else if (bytepos < 0)
14996 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14997 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14998 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15000 return list_ret;
15004 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
15005 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
15006 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
15007 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
15008 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
15009 to refer to register values). */
15011 static dw_loc_list_ref
15012 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
15014 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
15015 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
15016 int have_address = 0;
15017 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15019 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
15020 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
15021 problem... */
15023 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
15025 case ERROR_MARK:
15026 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
15027 return 0;
15029 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
15030 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
15031 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
15032 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
15033 the names of types. */
15034 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR");
15035 return 0;
15037 case CALL_EXPR:
15038 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
15039 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15040 return 0;
15042 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
15043 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
15044 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
15045 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
15046 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
15047 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15048 return 0;
15050 case ADDR_EXPR:
15051 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
15052 e.g. for &this->field. */
15053 if (want_address)
15055 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
15056 (loc, want_address == 2);
15057 if (list_ret)
15058 have_address = 1;
15059 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
15060 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15061 have_address = 1;
15063 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
15064 if (!list_ret && !ret)
15065 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
15066 else
15068 if (want_address)
15069 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
15070 return NULL;
15072 break;
15074 case VAR_DECL:
15075 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
15077 rtx rtl;
15078 enum dwarf_location_atom first_op;
15079 enum dwarf_location_atom second_op;
15080 bool dtprel = false;
15082 if (targetm.have_tls)
15084 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
15085 data. */
15086 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15087 return 0;
15089 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
15090 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
15091 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
15092 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
15093 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
15094 operand shouldn't be. */
15095 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
15096 return 0;
15097 first_op = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u;
15098 dtprel = true;
15099 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
15101 else
15103 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
15104 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
15105 return 0;
15106 loc = emutls_decl (loc);
15107 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
15108 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
15111 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15112 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15113 return 0;
15115 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
15116 return 0;
15117 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15118 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
15119 return 0;
15121 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
15122 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
15123 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
15124 ret->dtprel = dtprel;
15126 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
15127 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
15129 have_address = 1;
15130 break;
15132 /* FALLTHRU */
15134 case PARM_DECL:
15135 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
15136 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
15137 want_address);
15138 /* FALLTHRU */
15140 case RESULT_DECL:
15141 case FUNCTION_DECL:
15143 rtx rtl;
15144 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
15146 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
15148 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
15149 have_address = want_address != 0;
15150 break;
15152 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15153 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15155 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
15156 return 0;
15158 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
15160 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15161 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15162 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
15163 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
15165 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15167 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
15168 return 0;
15170 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15172 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
15173 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
15174 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
15176 else
15178 enum machine_mode mode;
15180 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
15181 if (want_address == 2)
15183 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
15184 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15185 have_address = 1;
15187 else
15189 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15190 if (MEM_P (rtl))
15192 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15193 have_address = 1;
15195 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15197 if (!ret)
15198 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
15199 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
15202 break;
15204 case MEM_REF:
15205 /* ??? FIXME. */
15206 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
15207 return 0;
15208 /* Fallthru. */
15209 case INDIRECT_REF:
15210 case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
15211 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15212 have_address = 1;
15213 break;
15215 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
15216 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
15218 CASE_CONVERT:
15219 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
15220 case SAVE_EXPR:
15221 case MODIFY_EXPR:
15222 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
15224 case COMPONENT_REF:
15225 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
15226 case ARRAY_REF:
15227 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
15228 case REALPART_EXPR:
15229 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
15231 tree obj, offset;
15232 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
15233 enum machine_mode mode;
15234 int volatilep;
15235 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15237 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
15238 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
15240 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
15242 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
15243 want_address == 2
15244 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1);
15245 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
15246 for nonzero bitpos. */
15247 if (list_ret == 0)
15248 return 0;
15249 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
15251 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15252 "bitfield access");
15253 return 0;
15256 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
15258 /* Variable offset. */
15259 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
15260 if (list_ret1 == 0)
15261 return 0;
15262 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15263 if (!list_ret)
15264 return 0;
15265 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15268 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15269 if (bytepos > 0)
15270 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
15271 else if (bytepos < 0)
15272 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
15274 have_address = 1;
15275 break;
15278 case INTEGER_CST:
15279 if ((want_address || !host_integerp (loc, 0))
15280 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15281 have_address = 1;
15282 else if (want_address == 2
15283 && host_integerp (loc, 0)
15284 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
15285 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
15286 tree_low_cst (loc, 0))))
15287 have_address = 1;
15288 else if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
15289 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
15290 else
15292 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15293 "Integer operand is not host integer");
15294 return 0;
15296 break;
15298 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15299 case REAL_CST:
15300 case STRING_CST:
15301 case COMPLEX_CST:
15302 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15303 have_address = 1;
15304 else
15305 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
15306 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15307 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
15308 break;
15310 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
15311 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
15312 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
15313 op = DW_OP_and;
15314 goto do_binop;
15316 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
15317 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
15318 op = DW_OP_xor;
15319 goto do_binop;
15321 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
15322 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
15323 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
15324 op = DW_OP_or;
15325 goto do_binop;
15327 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
15328 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
15329 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
15330 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
15331 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15332 return 0;
15333 op = DW_OP_div;
15334 goto do_binop;
15336 case MINUS_EXPR:
15337 op = DW_OP_minus;
15338 goto do_binop;
15340 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
15341 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
15342 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
15343 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
15344 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15346 op = DW_OP_mod;
15347 goto do_binop;
15349 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15350 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
15351 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
15352 return 0;
15354 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15355 if (list_ret == 0)
15356 return 0;
15357 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15358 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15359 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15360 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
15361 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15362 break;
15364 case MULT_EXPR:
15365 op = DW_OP_mul;
15366 goto do_binop;
15368 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
15369 op = DW_OP_shl;
15370 goto do_binop;
15372 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
15373 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
15374 goto do_binop;
15376 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
15377 case PLUS_EXPR:
15378 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
15380 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15381 if (list_ret == 0)
15382 return 0;
15384 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0));
15385 break;
15388 op = DW_OP_plus;
15389 goto do_binop;
15391 case LE_EXPR:
15392 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15393 return 0;
15395 op = DW_OP_le;
15396 goto do_binop;
15398 case GE_EXPR:
15399 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15400 return 0;
15402 op = DW_OP_ge;
15403 goto do_binop;
15405 case LT_EXPR:
15406 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15407 return 0;
15409 op = DW_OP_lt;
15410 goto do_binop;
15412 case GT_EXPR:
15413 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
15414 return 0;
15416 op = DW_OP_gt;
15417 goto do_binop;
15419 case EQ_EXPR:
15420 op = DW_OP_eq;
15421 goto do_binop;
15423 case NE_EXPR:
15424 op = DW_OP_ne;
15425 goto do_binop;
15427 do_binop:
15428 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15429 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
15430 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
15431 return 0;
15433 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15434 if (list_ret == 0)
15435 return 0;
15436 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15437 break;
15439 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
15440 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
15441 op = DW_OP_not;
15442 goto do_unop;
15444 case ABS_EXPR:
15445 op = DW_OP_abs;
15446 goto do_unop;
15448 case NEGATE_EXPR:
15449 op = DW_OP_neg;
15450 goto do_unop;
15452 do_unop:
15453 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15454 if (list_ret == 0)
15455 return 0;
15457 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15458 break;
15460 case MIN_EXPR:
15461 case MAX_EXPR:
15463 const enum tree_code code =
15464 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
15466 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
15467 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
15468 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
15469 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
15472 /* ... fall through ... */
15474 case COND_EXPR:
15476 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
15477 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
15478 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
15479 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
15480 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
15482 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
15483 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
15484 return 0;
15486 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15487 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
15489 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
15490 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15491 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
15493 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
15494 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15495 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
15497 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
15498 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
15499 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
15500 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15501 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
15503 break;
15505 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
15506 return 0;
15508 default:
15509 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
15510 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
15511 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
15512 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
15514 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15515 "language specific tree node");
15516 return 0;
15519 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
15520 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
15521 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
15522 gcc_unreachable ();
15523 #else
15524 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
15525 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
15526 return NULL;
15527 #endif
15530 if (!ret && !list_ret)
15531 return 0;
15533 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
15534 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15536 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15538 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15539 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15540 return 0;
15542 if (ret)
15543 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15544 else
15545 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15546 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15547 have_address = 1;
15549 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
15550 if (want_address && !have_address)
15552 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15553 "Want address and only have value");
15554 return 0;
15557 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
15559 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
15560 if (!want_address && have_address)
15562 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15564 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
15566 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15567 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15568 return 0;
15570 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15571 op = DW_OP_deref;
15572 else
15573 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
15575 if (ret)
15576 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15577 else
15578 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15580 if (ret)
15581 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
15583 return list_ret;
15586 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
15587 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15588 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
15590 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address);
15591 if (!ret)
15592 return NULL;
15593 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
15595 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15596 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
15597 return NULL;
15599 return ret->expr;
15602 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
15603 which is not less than the value itself. */
15605 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
15606 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
15608 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
15611 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
15612 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
15613 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
15614 ERROR_MARK node. */
15616 static inline tree
15617 field_type (const_tree decl)
15619 tree type;
15621 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15622 return integer_type_node;
15624 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
15625 if (type == NULL_TREE)
15626 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
15628 return type;
15631 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
15632 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
15633 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
15635 static inline unsigned
15636 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
15638 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
15641 static inline unsigned
15642 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
15644 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
15647 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
15649 static inline double_int
15650 round_up_to_align (double_int t, unsigned int align)
15652 double_int alignd = uhwi_to_double_int (align);
15653 t = double_int_add (t, alignd);
15654 t = double_int_add (t, double_int_minus_one);
15655 t = double_int_div (t, alignd, true, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
15656 t = double_int_mul (t, alignd);
15657 return t;
15660 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
15661 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
15662 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
15663 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
15664 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
15665 just yet). */
15667 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15668 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
15670 double_int object_offset_in_bits;
15671 double_int object_offset_in_bytes;
15672 double_int bitpos_int;
15674 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15675 return 0;
15677 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
15679 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
15680 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
15681 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
15682 if (TREE_CODE (bit_position (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
15683 return 0;
15685 bitpos_int = tree_to_double_int (bit_position (decl));
15687 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
15688 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
15690 tree type;
15691 tree field_size_tree;
15692 double_int deepest_bitpos;
15693 double_int field_size_in_bits;
15694 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
15695 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
15696 double_int type_size_in_bits;
15698 type = field_type (decl);
15699 type_size_in_bits = double_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
15700 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
15702 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
15704 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
15705 a flexible array member. */
15706 if (!field_size_tree)
15707 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
15709 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
15710 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
15711 field_size_in_bits = tree_to_double_int (field_size_tree);
15712 else
15713 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
15715 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
15717 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
15718 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
15719 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
15720 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
15721 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
15722 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
15723 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
15724 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
15725 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
15727 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
15729 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
15730 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
15731 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
15732 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
15733 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
15734 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
15735 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
15736 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
15737 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
15738 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
15739 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
15741 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
15742 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
15743 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
15744 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
15745 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
15746 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
15747 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
15748 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
15749 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
15750 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
15751 structure type.)
15753 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
15754 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
15755 must have believed that the containing object started (within
15756 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
15757 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
15758 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
15759 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
15761 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
15762 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
15763 deepest_bitpos = double_int_add (bitpos_int, field_size_in_bits);
15765 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
15766 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
15767 be. */
15768 object_offset_in_bits
15769 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
15771 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
15772 bitfields. */
15773 object_offset_in_bits
15774 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
15776 if (double_int_ucmp (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int) > 0)
15778 object_offset_in_bits
15779 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
15781 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
15782 object_offset_in_bits
15783 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
15786 else
15787 #endif
15788 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
15790 object_offset_in_bytes
15791 = double_int_div (object_offset_in_bits,
15792 uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_UNIT), true,
15793 TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
15794 return double_int_to_shwi (object_offset_in_bytes);
15797 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
15798 associated with them. */
15800 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
15802 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
15803 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
15804 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
15806 static inline void
15807 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
15808 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
15810 if (descr == 0)
15811 return;
15812 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
15813 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
15814 else
15815 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
15818 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
15820 static void
15821 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15823 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
15824 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
15825 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
15826 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
15829 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
15830 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
15831 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
15832 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
15833 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
15834 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
15835 function above).
15837 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
15838 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
15839 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
15840 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
15841 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
15842 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
15843 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
15844 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
15845 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
15846 function below.) */
15848 static void
15849 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15851 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
15852 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
15854 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
15856 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
15857 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
15859 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
15860 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
15861 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
15862 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
15864 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
15866 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
15868 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
15870 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
15871 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15872 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15874 /* Extract the vtable address. */
15875 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15876 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15878 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
15879 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
15880 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
15882 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
15883 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15884 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
15885 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15887 /* Extract the offset. */
15888 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15889 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15891 /* Add it to the object address. */
15892 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
15893 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15895 else
15896 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
15898 else
15899 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
15901 if (! loc_descr)
15903 if (dwarf_version > 2)
15905 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
15906 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
15907 return;
15909 else
15911 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15913 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
15914 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
15915 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
15917 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
15918 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
15919 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
15920 stack. */
15921 op = DW_OP_constu;
15922 #else
15923 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
15924 #endif
15926 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
15930 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
15933 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
15935 static void
15936 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
15938 while (size != 0)
15940 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
15941 val >>= 8;
15942 --size;
15946 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
15948 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15949 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
15951 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
15953 src += size;
15954 while (size != 0)
15956 val <<= 8;
15957 val |= *--src & 0xff;
15958 --size;
15960 return val;
15963 /* Writes double_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
15965 static void
15966 insert_double (double_int val, unsigned char *dest)
15968 unsigned char *p0 = dest;
15969 unsigned char *p1 = dest + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
15971 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15973 p0 = p1;
15974 p1 = dest;
15977 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.low, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
15978 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.high, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
15981 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
15983 static void
15984 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
15986 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
15987 long val[4];
15988 int i;
15990 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
15991 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
15993 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
15994 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
15996 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
15997 array += 4;
16001 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
16002 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
16003 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
16004 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
16005 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
16007 static bool
16008 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
16010 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
16012 case CONST_INT:
16014 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
16016 if (val < 0)
16017 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
16018 else
16019 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
16021 return true;
16023 case CONST_DOUBLE:
16024 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
16025 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
16026 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
16027 represented. */
16029 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16031 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
16033 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
16034 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
16036 insert_float (rtl, array);
16037 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
16039 else
16040 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
16041 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
16043 return true;
16045 case CONST_VECTOR:
16047 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16048 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
16049 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
16050 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic
16051 (length * elt_size);
16052 unsigned int i;
16053 unsigned char *p;
16055 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
16057 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
16058 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16060 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16061 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
16063 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
16064 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
16065 else
16067 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
16068 insert_double (val, p);
16071 break;
16073 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
16074 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16076 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16077 insert_float (elt, p);
16079 break;
16081 default:
16082 gcc_unreachable ();
16085 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
16087 return true;
16089 case CONST_STRING:
16090 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16092 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
16093 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
16094 rtl_addr:
16095 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
16096 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
16097 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
16098 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16099 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
16100 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
16101 return true;
16103 return false;
16105 case CONST:
16106 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
16107 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
16108 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16109 case SYMBOL_REF:
16110 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16111 return false;
16112 case LABEL_REF:
16113 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16114 goto rtl_addr;
16115 return false;
16117 case PLUS:
16118 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
16119 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
16120 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
16121 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
16122 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
16123 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
16124 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
16125 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
16126 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
16127 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
16128 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
16129 return false;
16131 case HIGH:
16132 case CONST_FIXED:
16133 return false;
16135 case MEM:
16136 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
16137 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
16138 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
16140 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
16141 return true;
16143 return false;
16145 default:
16146 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
16147 gcc_unreachable ();
16149 return false;
16152 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
16153 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
16154 output). */
16155 static tree
16156 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
16157 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16159 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
16160 *walk_subtrees = 0;
16162 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
16163 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
16164 return *tp;
16165 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
16166 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
16167 be conservative. */
16168 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
16169 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
16170 return *tp;
16171 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
16173 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (*tp);
16174 if (!node || !node->needed)
16175 return *tp;
16177 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
16178 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
16180 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
16181 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
16182 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
16183 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
16184 if (!cgraph_get_node (*tp))
16185 return *tp;
16187 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
16188 return *tp;
16190 return NULL_TREE;
16193 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
16194 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
16196 static rtx
16197 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
16199 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
16201 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
16202 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
16203 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16205 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
16206 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
16207 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
16209 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
16210 && domain
16211 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
16212 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
16213 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
16214 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
16215 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
16217 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
16218 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
16219 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
16220 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
16223 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
16224 CONCAT: FIXME! */
16225 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
16227 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
16228 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
16229 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
16231 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
16232 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
16233 reference variables which won't be output. */
16234 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
16235 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
16237 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
16238 possible. */
16239 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
16240 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
16242 case VECTOR_CST:
16243 break;
16244 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16245 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
16247 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
16248 bool constant_p = true;
16249 tree value;
16250 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
16252 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
16253 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
16254 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
16255 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
16256 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
16258 constant_p = false;
16259 break;
16262 if (constant_p)
16264 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
16265 break;
16268 /* FALLTHRU */
16270 default:
16271 return NULL;
16274 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
16276 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
16277 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
16280 return rtl;
16283 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
16285 static rtx
16286 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
16288 rtx rtl;
16290 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
16291 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
16292 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
16294 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
16295 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
16296 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
16297 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
16298 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
16299 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
16300 referenced within the function.
16302 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
16303 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
16304 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
16305 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
16307 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
16308 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
16309 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
16310 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
16311 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
16312 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
16314 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
16315 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
16316 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
16317 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
16318 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
16319 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
16320 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
16321 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
16322 output at debug-time.
16324 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
16325 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
16326 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
16327 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
16328 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
16329 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
16330 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
16331 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
16332 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
16333 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
16334 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
16335 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
16336 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
16338 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
16339 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
16340 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
16341 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
16342 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
16343 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
16344 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
16345 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
16346 I'd like to fix it.
16348 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
16349 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
16350 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
16351 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
16352 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
16353 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
16354 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
16355 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
16356 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
16357 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
16358 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
16360 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
16361 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
16363 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
16364 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
16365 fixed registers. */
16366 if (! reload_completed)
16368 if (rtl
16369 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
16370 || (MEM_P (rtl)
16371 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
16372 || (REG_P (rtl)
16373 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16374 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
16376 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
16377 return rtl;
16379 rtl = NULL_RTX;
16381 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
16383 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
16385 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
16386 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
16387 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
16388 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
16390 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
16391 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
16392 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
16393 if (dmode == pmode)
16394 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
16395 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
16396 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
16397 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
16399 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
16400 if (REG_P (inc))
16401 rtl = inc;
16402 else if (MEM_P (inc))
16404 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16405 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
16406 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
16407 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
16408 else
16409 rtl = inc;
16414 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
16415 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
16416 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
16417 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
16418 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
16419 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
16420 thing to do. */
16421 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
16422 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
16423 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16424 /* Not passed in memory. */
16425 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
16426 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
16427 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16428 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
16429 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
16430 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
16431 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
16432 #endif
16434 /* Big endian correction check. */
16435 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
16436 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
16437 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
16438 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
16440 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
16441 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
16443 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
16444 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
16447 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16448 && rtl
16449 && MEM_P (rtl)
16450 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
16451 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16453 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
16454 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
16456 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
16457 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
16458 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
16459 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
16460 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
16461 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
16462 if (rsize > dsize)
16463 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
16464 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
16467 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
16468 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
16469 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
16470 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
16471 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
16473 if (rtl)
16474 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
16476 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
16477 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
16478 code, and thus is not emitted. */
16479 if (rtl)
16480 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
16482 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
16483 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
16484 it. */
16485 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
16486 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16487 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
16488 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
16489 && DECL_NAME (decl)
16490 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
16491 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
16493 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
16494 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
16495 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
16496 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
16497 rtl = NULL_RTX;
16500 return rtl;
16503 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
16504 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
16505 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
16507 static tree
16508 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
16510 tree val_expr, cvar;
16511 enum machine_mode mode;
16512 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
16513 tree offset;
16514 int volatilep = 0, unsignedp = 0;
16516 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
16517 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
16518 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
16519 be handled as such. */
16520 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
16521 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
16522 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
16523 || !is_fortran ())
16524 return NULL_TREE;
16526 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
16527 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
16528 return NULL_TREE;
16530 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
16531 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
16533 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
16534 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
16535 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
16536 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
16537 return NULL_TREE;
16539 *value = 0;
16540 if (offset != NULL)
16542 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
16543 return NULL_TREE;
16544 *value = tree_low_cst (offset, 0);
16546 if (bitpos != 0)
16547 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16549 return cvar;
16552 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
16553 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
16554 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
16555 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
16556 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
16557 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
16558 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
16559 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
16560 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
16561 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
16563 static bool
16564 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
16565 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
16567 rtx rtl;
16568 dw_loc_list_ref list;
16569 var_loc_list *loc_list;
16571 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16572 return false;
16574 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
16575 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
16577 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
16578 the location. */
16580 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
16581 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16582 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
16583 return true;
16585 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
16586 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
16587 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
16588 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
16589 if (loc_list
16590 && loc_list->first
16591 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
16592 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
16593 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
16594 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
16596 struct var_loc_node *node;
16598 node = loc_list->first;
16599 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
16600 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
16601 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
16602 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16603 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
16604 return true;
16606 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2);
16607 if (list)
16609 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
16610 return true;
16612 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
16613 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
16614 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
16617 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
16619 static void
16620 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
16622 deferred_locations entry;
16623 entry.variable = variable;
16624 entry.die = die;
16625 VEC_safe_push (deferred_locations, gc, deferred_locations_list, &entry);
16628 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
16629 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
16631 static bool
16632 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
16634 tree type;
16636 if (init == NULL_TREE)
16637 return false;
16639 STRIP_NOPS (init);
16640 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
16642 case STRING_CST:
16643 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
16644 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16646 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
16647 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
16649 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
16650 return false;
16651 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16652 return false;
16653 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
16655 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
16656 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
16657 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
16658 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
16660 else
16661 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
16662 return true;
16664 return false;
16665 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16666 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
16667 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16668 return false;
16669 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16671 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
16672 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
16673 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
16674 constructor_elt *ce;
16676 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
16677 || !host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0))
16678 return false;
16680 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
16681 if (fieldsize <= 0)
16682 return false;
16684 min_index = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0);
16685 memset (array, '\0', size);
16686 for (cnt = 0;
16687 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce);
16688 cnt++)
16690 tree val = ce->value;
16691 tree index = ce->index;
16692 int pos = curpos;
16693 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
16694 pos = (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0) - min_index)
16695 * fieldsize;
16696 else if (index)
16697 pos = (tree_low_cst (index, 0) - min_index) * fieldsize;
16699 if (val)
16701 STRIP_NOPS (val);
16702 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
16703 return false;
16705 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
16706 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
16708 int count = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1), 0)
16709 - tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0);
16710 while (count > 0)
16712 if (val)
16713 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
16714 curpos += fieldsize;
16717 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
16719 return true;
16721 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
16722 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
16724 tree field = NULL_TREE;
16725 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
16726 constructor_elt *ce;
16728 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16729 return false;
16731 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
16732 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
16734 for (cnt = 0;
16735 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce);
16736 cnt++, field = field ? DECL_CHAIN (field) : 0)
16738 tree val = ce->value;
16739 int pos, fieldsize;
16741 if (ce->index != 0)
16742 field = ce->index;
16744 if (val)
16745 STRIP_NOPS (val);
16747 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
16748 return false;
16750 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
16751 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
16752 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
16753 return false;
16754 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
16755 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0))
16756 return false;
16757 fieldsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0);
16758 pos = int_byte_position (field);
16759 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
16760 if (val
16761 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
16762 return false;
16764 return true;
16766 return false;
16767 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16768 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
16769 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
16770 default:
16771 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
16775 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
16776 attribute is the const value T. */
16778 static bool
16779 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
16781 tree init;
16782 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
16783 rtx rtl;
16785 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
16786 return false;
16788 init = t;
16789 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
16791 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
16792 if (rtl)
16793 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
16794 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
16795 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
16796 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
16798 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
16799 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
16801 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
16802 ggc_alloc_cleared_atomic (size);
16804 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
16806 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
16807 return true;
16811 return false;
16814 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
16815 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
16816 variable with static storage duration
16817 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
16819 static bool
16820 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
16823 if (!decl
16824 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
16825 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL))
16826 return false;
16828 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
16829 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
16830 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
16831 /* OK */;
16832 else
16833 return false;
16835 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
16836 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
16837 return false;
16839 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
16842 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
16843 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
16844 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
16845 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
16846 expressions. */
16848 static dw_loc_list_ref
16849 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16851 dw_fde_ref fde;
16852 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
16853 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
16854 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
16855 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
16856 dw_cfa_location remember;
16858 fde = current_fde ();
16859 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
16861 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
16862 list_tail = &list;
16863 list = NULL;
16865 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
16866 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
16867 remember = next_cfa;
16869 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
16871 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
16872 advance opcodes. */
16873 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
16874 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
16876 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16877 last_label = start_label;
16879 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
16880 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
16882 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
16883 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
16884 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
16885 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
16886 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16888 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16889 start_label, last_label, section);
16891 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16892 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16893 start_label = last_label;
16895 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
16896 break;
16898 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
16899 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
16900 gcc_unreachable ();
16902 default:
16903 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
16904 break;
16907 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16909 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16910 start_label, last_label, section);
16911 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16912 start_label = last_label;
16915 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
16916 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
16918 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
16919 gen_llsym (list);
16921 return list;
16924 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
16925 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
16926 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
16927 before the latter is negated. */
16929 static void
16930 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16932 rtx reg, elim;
16934 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
16935 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
16936 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16937 #else
16938 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
16939 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16940 #endif
16942 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
16943 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
16945 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
16946 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
16949 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
16950 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16951 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
16952 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
16953 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16954 : stack_pointer_rtx));
16956 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
16959 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
16960 the value of the attribute. */
16962 static void
16963 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
16965 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
16967 if (demangle_name_func)
16968 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
16970 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
16974 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
16976 static void
16977 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
16979 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
16980 char *wd1;
16982 if (wd == NULL)
16983 return;
16985 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
16987 int wdlen;
16989 wdlen = strlen (wd);
16990 wd1 = (char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (wdlen + 2);
16991 strcpy (wd1, wd);
16992 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
16993 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
16994 wd = wd1;
16997 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
17000 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
17001 default. */
17003 static int
17004 lower_bound_default (void)
17006 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language))
17008 case DW_LANG_C:
17009 case DW_LANG_C89:
17010 case DW_LANG_C99:
17011 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
17012 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
17013 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
17014 case DW_LANG_Java:
17015 return 0;
17016 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
17017 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
17018 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
17019 return 1;
17020 case DW_LANG_UPC:
17021 case DW_LANG_D:
17022 case DW_LANG_Python:
17023 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
17024 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
17025 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
17026 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
17027 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
17028 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
17029 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
17030 case DW_LANG_PLI:
17031 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
17032 default:
17033 return -1;
17037 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
17038 a representation for that bound. */
17040 static void
17041 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
17043 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
17045 case ERROR_MARK:
17046 return;
17048 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
17049 case INTEGER_CST:
17051 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (bound));
17052 int dflt;
17054 /* Use the default if possible. */
17055 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
17056 && host_integerp (bound, 0)
17057 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
17058 && tree_low_cst (bound, 0) == dflt)
17061 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with the
17062 precision of its type. The precision and signedness of the
17063 type will be necessary to re-interpret it unambiguously. */
17064 else if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
17066 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
17067 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1;
17068 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
17069 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound) & mask);
17071 else if (prec == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
17072 || TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound) == 0)
17073 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
17074 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
17075 else
17076 add_AT_double (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound),
17077 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
17079 break;
17081 CASE_CONVERT:
17082 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17083 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
17084 break;
17086 case SAVE_EXPR:
17087 break;
17089 case VAR_DECL:
17090 case PARM_DECL:
17091 case RESULT_DECL:
17093 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
17095 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
17096 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
17097 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
17098 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
17099 later parameter. */
17100 if (decl_die != NULL)
17102 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
17103 break;
17106 /* FALLTHRU */
17108 default:
17110 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
17111 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
17113 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
17114 dw_loc_list_ref list;
17116 list = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 2);
17117 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
17119 /* If DW_AT_*bound is not a reference nor constant, it is
17120 a DWARF expression rather than location description.
17121 For that loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0) is needed.
17122 If that fails to give a single element list,
17123 fall back to outputting this as a reference anyway. */
17124 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0);
17125 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
17127 add_AT_loc (subrange_die, bound_attr, list2->expr);
17128 break;
17131 if (list == NULL)
17132 break;
17134 if (current_function_decl == 0)
17135 ctx = comp_unit_die;
17136 else
17137 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
17139 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
17140 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17141 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
17142 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
17143 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
17144 break;
17149 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
17150 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
17151 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
17152 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
17154 static void
17155 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
17157 unsigned dimension_number;
17158 tree lower, upper;
17159 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
17161 for (dimension_number = 0;
17162 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
17163 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
17165 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
17167 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
17168 break;
17170 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
17171 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
17172 here. */
17173 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
17174 if (domain)
17176 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
17177 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
17178 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
17180 /* Define the index type. */
17181 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
17183 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
17184 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
17185 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
17186 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
17187 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
17188 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
17189 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
17191 else
17192 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
17193 type_die);
17196 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
17197 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
17198 dimension arr(N:*)
17199 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
17200 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
17201 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
17203 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
17204 if (upper)
17205 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
17208 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
17209 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
17210 bounds. */
17214 static void
17215 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
17217 unsigned size;
17219 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
17221 case ERROR_MARK:
17222 size = 0;
17223 break;
17224 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
17225 case RECORD_TYPE:
17226 case UNION_TYPE:
17227 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
17228 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
17229 break;
17230 case FIELD_DECL:
17231 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
17232 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
17233 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
17234 even for bit-fields. */
17235 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17236 break;
17237 default:
17238 gcc_unreachable ();
17241 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
17242 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
17243 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
17244 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
17245 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17248 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
17249 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
17250 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
17251 bit-field itself.
17253 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
17254 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
17255 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
17256 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
17257 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
17258 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
17260 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
17261 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
17262 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
17264 static inline void
17265 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17267 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
17268 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
17269 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
17270 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
17271 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
17272 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
17274 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
17275 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
17277 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
17278 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
17279 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
17280 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
17281 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
17282 return;
17284 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
17286 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
17287 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
17288 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
17289 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
17290 below must take account of these differences. */
17291 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
17292 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
17294 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17296 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
17297 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
17300 bit_offset
17301 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
17302 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
17303 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
17305 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
17308 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
17309 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
17311 static inline void
17312 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17314 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
17315 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
17316 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
17318 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
17319 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
17322 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
17323 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
17325 static inline void
17326 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
17328 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
17329 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
17330 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
17333 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
17334 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
17335 equate table. */
17337 static inline dw_die_ref
17338 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
17340 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
17342 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
17344 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
17345 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
17346 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
17348 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
17349 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
17350 tree fn = origin;
17352 if (TYPE_P (fn))
17353 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
17355 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
17356 if (fn)
17357 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
17360 if (DECL_P (origin))
17361 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
17362 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
17363 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
17365 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
17366 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
17367 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
17368 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
17369 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
17370 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
17371 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
17372 here. */
17374 if (origin_die)
17375 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
17376 return origin_die;
17379 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
17381 static inline void
17382 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
17384 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
17386 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
17388 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
17389 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
17390 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
17391 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
17392 0));
17394 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
17395 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
17396 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
17397 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
17398 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
17402 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
17403 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
17404 standardized it. */
17406 static void
17407 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17409 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
17411 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
17412 if (name[0] == '*')
17413 name = &name[1];
17415 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
17416 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
17417 else
17418 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
17421 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
17423 static void
17424 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17426 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
17428 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
17429 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
17432 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
17434 static void
17435 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17437 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
17438 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
17439 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
17440 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
17441 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
17443 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
17444 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
17446 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
17448 asm_name = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
17449 asm_name->die = die;
17450 asm_name->created_for = decl;
17451 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
17452 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
17454 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
17455 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
17459 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
17460 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
17462 static void
17463 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17465 tree decl_name;
17467 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
17468 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
17470 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
17471 if (name)
17472 add_name_attribute (die, name);
17473 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17474 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
17476 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
17479 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17480 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
17481 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
17482 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
17484 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
17485 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
17486 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
17488 #endif
17491 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17493 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
17495 void
17496 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
17498 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17499 dw_die_ref die;
17501 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
17502 die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
17503 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
17504 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
17505 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
17506 current_function_funcdef_no);
17507 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
17509 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die. */
17510 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die;
17511 if (comp_unit_die->die_child)
17513 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die->die_child->die_sib;
17514 comp_unit_die->die_child->die_sib = die;
17516 else
17518 die->die_sib = die;
17519 comp_unit_die->die_child = die;
17522 #endif
17524 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
17526 static void
17527 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
17529 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
17532 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
17534 static inline void
17535 pop_decl_scope (void)
17537 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
17540 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
17541 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
17542 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
17543 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
17544 the current active scope. */
17546 static dw_die_ref
17547 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
17549 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
17550 tree containing_scope;
17551 int i;
17553 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
17554 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
17556 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
17558 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
17559 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
17561 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
17562 /* OK */;
17563 else
17564 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
17567 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
17568 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
17569 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
17570 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
17571 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
17573 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
17574 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
17575 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
17577 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
17578 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
17579 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
17580 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
17581 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
17582 break;
17584 if (i < 0)
17586 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
17587 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
17589 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
17590 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
17592 else
17593 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
17595 else
17596 scope_die = context_die;
17598 return scope_die;
17601 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
17603 static inline int
17604 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17606 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
17607 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
17608 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
17609 return 1;
17611 return 0;
17614 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
17616 static inline int
17617 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17619 return (context_die
17620 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
17621 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
17622 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
17623 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
17626 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
17627 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
17629 static inline int
17630 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17632 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
17633 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
17636 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
17637 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
17638 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
17640 static void
17641 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
17642 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
17644 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
17645 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
17647 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
17648 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
17649 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
17650 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
17651 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
17652 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
17653 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
17655 if (code == ERROR_MARK
17656 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
17657 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
17658 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
17659 || code == VOID_TYPE)
17660 return;
17662 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
17663 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
17664 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
17665 context_die);
17667 if (type_die != NULL)
17668 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
17671 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
17672 function call type. */
17673 static void
17674 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
17676 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
17678 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
17679 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
17681 /* DWARF doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
17682 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
17683 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
17684 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we use this for the
17685 time being, following existing custom. */
17686 if (is_fortran ()
17687 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
17688 value = DW_CC_program;
17690 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
17691 is not DW_CC_normal. */
17692 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
17693 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
17696 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
17697 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
17698 was declared without a tag. */
17700 static const char *
17701 type_tag (const_tree type)
17703 const char *name = 0;
17705 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
17707 tree t = 0;
17709 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
17710 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
17711 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
17713 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
17714 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
17715 involved. */
17716 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
17717 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
17719 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
17720 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
17721 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
17722 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
17723 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
17724 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
17727 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
17728 if (!name && t != 0)
17729 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
17732 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
17735 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
17736 for bit field types. */
17738 static inline tree
17739 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
17741 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
17742 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
17745 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
17746 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
17748 #if 0
17749 static const char *
17750 decl_start_label (tree decl)
17752 rtx x;
17753 const char *fnname;
17755 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
17756 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
17758 x = XEXP (x, 0);
17759 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
17761 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
17762 return fnname;
17764 #endif
17766 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
17767 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
17768 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
17770 static void
17771 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17773 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
17774 dw_die_ref array_die;
17776 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
17777 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
17778 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
17779 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
17780 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
17781 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
17782 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
17783 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
17784 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
17786 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
17787 tree element_type;
17789 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
17790 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
17791 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
17792 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
17793 && is_fortran ()
17794 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
17796 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
17798 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
17799 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17800 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17801 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
17802 if (size >= 0)
17803 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17804 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
17805 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
17806 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
17808 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
17809 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2);
17811 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
17812 if (loc && size > 0)
17814 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
17815 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
17816 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17819 return;
17822 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types
17823 (e.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10]) unless the inner
17824 array type comes before the outer array type. We thus call gen_type_die
17825 before we new_die and must prevent nested array types collapsing for this
17826 target. */
17828 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17829 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
17830 collapse_nested_arrays = false;
17831 #endif
17833 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
17834 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17835 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17837 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
17839 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
17840 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
17841 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
17842 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
17845 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
17846 if (is_fortran ()
17847 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
17848 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
17849 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
17850 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
17852 #if 0
17853 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
17854 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
17855 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
17856 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
17857 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
17858 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
17859 for multidimensional arrays. */
17860 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
17861 #endif
17863 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17864 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
17865 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
17866 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
17867 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17868 else
17869 #endif
17870 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
17872 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
17873 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
17874 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
17875 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
17876 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17878 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
17879 break;
17880 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
17883 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17884 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
17885 #endif
17887 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
17889 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
17890 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
17893 static dw_loc_descr_ref
17894 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
17896 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
17897 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
17898 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
17900 if (val == base_decl)
17901 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
17903 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
17905 CASE_CONVERT:
17906 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
17907 case VAR_DECL:
17908 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, 0);
17909 case INTEGER_CST:
17910 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
17911 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
17912 break;
17913 case INDIRECT_REF:
17914 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
17915 if (size < 0)
17916 break;
17917 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
17918 if (!loc)
17919 break;
17920 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
17921 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
17922 else
17923 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
17924 return loc;
17925 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
17926 case PLUS_EXPR:
17927 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
17928 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
17929 < 16384)
17931 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
17932 if (!loc)
17933 break;
17934 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 0));
17936 else
17938 op = DW_OP_plus;
17939 do_binop:
17940 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
17941 if (!loc)
17942 break;
17943 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
17944 if (!loc2)
17945 break;
17946 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
17947 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
17949 return loc;
17950 case MINUS_EXPR:
17951 op = DW_OP_minus;
17952 goto do_binop;
17953 case MULT_EXPR:
17954 op = DW_OP_mul;
17955 goto do_binop;
17956 case EQ_EXPR:
17957 op = DW_OP_eq;
17958 goto do_binop;
17959 case NE_EXPR:
17960 op = DW_OP_ne;
17961 goto do_binop;
17962 default:
17963 break;
17965 return NULL;
17968 static void
17969 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
17970 tree val, tree base_decl)
17972 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
17974 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
17976 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
17977 return;
17980 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
17981 if (!loc)
17982 return;
17984 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
17987 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
17988 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
17990 static void
17991 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
17992 dw_die_ref context_die)
17994 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
17995 dw_die_ref array_die;
17996 int dim;
17998 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
17999 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
18000 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
18002 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
18003 if (is_fortran ()
18004 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
18005 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
18007 if (info->data_location)
18008 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
18009 info->base_decl);
18010 if (info->associated)
18011 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
18012 info->base_decl);
18013 if (info->allocated)
18014 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
18015 info->base_decl);
18017 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
18019 dw_die_ref subrange_die
18020 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
18022 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
18024 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
18025 int dflt;
18027 if (host_integerp (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0)
18028 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
18029 && tree_low_cst (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0) == dflt)
18031 else
18032 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
18033 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
18034 info->base_decl);
18036 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
18037 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
18038 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
18039 info->base_decl);
18040 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
18041 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
18042 info->dimen[dim].stride,
18043 info->base_decl);
18046 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
18047 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
18049 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
18050 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
18053 #if 0
18054 static void
18055 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18057 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18058 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
18060 if (origin != NULL)
18061 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
18062 else
18064 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
18065 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
18066 0, 0, context_die);
18069 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18070 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
18071 else
18072 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
18074 #endif
18076 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
18077 emit full debugging info for them. */
18079 static void
18080 retry_incomplete_types (void)
18082 int i;
18084 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
18085 if (should_emit_struct_debug (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i),
18086 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
18087 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
18090 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
18092 static enum dwarf_tag
18093 record_type_tag (tree type)
18095 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
18096 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
18098 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
18100 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
18101 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
18103 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
18104 return DW_TAG_class_type;
18106 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
18107 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18108 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
18109 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
18111 default:
18112 gcc_unreachable ();
18116 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
18117 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
18118 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
18119 DIE. */
18121 static dw_die_ref
18122 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18124 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18126 if (type_die == NULL)
18128 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
18129 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18130 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18131 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
18132 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18133 && ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
18134 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
18136 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
18137 return type_die;
18138 else
18139 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18141 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
18142 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
18143 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
18144 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
18146 tree link;
18148 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18149 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
18150 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
18152 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18153 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18156 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
18157 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
18158 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
18159 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
18161 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
18162 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
18164 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
18165 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
18167 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
18168 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
18170 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
18171 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
18173 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
18174 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
18175 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
18176 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
18177 values as if they were signed. That means that
18178 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
18179 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
18180 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
18181 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
18184 else
18185 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18187 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18188 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
18190 return type_die;
18193 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
18194 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
18195 type.
18197 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
18198 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
18199 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
18200 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
18201 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
18202 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
18203 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
18204 argument type of some subprogram type.
18205 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
18206 are emitted. */
18208 static dw_die_ref
18209 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
18210 dw_die_ref context_die)
18212 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
18213 tree ultimate_origin;
18214 dw_die_ref parm_die
18215 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
18217 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
18219 case tcc_declaration:
18220 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
18221 if (node || ultimate_origin)
18222 origin = ultimate_origin;
18223 if (origin != NULL)
18224 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
18225 else if (emit_name_p)
18226 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
18227 if (origin == NULL
18228 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin)
18229 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
18230 decl_function_context
18231 (node_or_origin))))
18233 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
18234 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
18235 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0,
18236 context_die);
18237 else
18238 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
18239 TREE_READONLY (node_or_origin),
18240 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node_or_origin),
18241 context_die);
18243 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
18244 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18246 if (node && node != origin)
18247 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
18248 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin))
18249 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
18250 DW_AT_location);
18252 break;
18254 case tcc_type:
18255 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
18256 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, 0, 0, context_die);
18257 break;
18259 default:
18260 gcc_unreachable ();
18263 return parm_die;
18266 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
18267 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
18268 parameter pack.
18270 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
18271 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
18272 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
18273 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
18274 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
18275 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
18277 static dw_die_ref
18278 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
18279 tree pack_arg,
18280 dw_die_ref subr_die,
18281 tree *next_arg)
18283 tree arg;
18284 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
18286 gcc_assert (parm_pack
18287 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
18288 && subr_die);
18290 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
18291 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
18293 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
18295 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
18296 parm_pack))
18297 break;
18298 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
18299 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
18300 parm_pack_die);
18302 if (next_arg)
18303 *next_arg = arg;
18304 return parm_pack_die;
18307 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
18308 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
18310 static void
18311 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18313 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
18316 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
18317 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
18318 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
18319 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
18321 static void
18322 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18324 tree link;
18325 tree formal_type = NULL;
18326 tree first_parm_type;
18327 tree arg;
18329 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18331 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
18332 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
18334 else
18335 arg = NULL_TREE;
18337 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
18339 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
18340 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
18341 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
18343 dw_die_ref parm_die;
18345 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
18346 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
18347 break;
18349 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
18350 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
18351 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
18352 context_die);
18353 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
18354 && link == first_parm_type)
18355 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
18356 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18358 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
18359 if (arg)
18360 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
18363 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
18364 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
18365 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
18366 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
18368 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
18369 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
18370 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
18371 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
18372 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
18373 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
18376 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
18377 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
18378 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
18379 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
18380 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
18382 static void
18383 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
18385 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
18387 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
18388 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
18389 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18390 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
18391 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
18393 dw_die_ref type_die;
18394 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
18396 push_decl_scope (type);
18397 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18398 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18399 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
18400 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
18402 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
18403 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
18404 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
18405 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
18406 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
18408 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
18409 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
18412 else
18413 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
18415 pop_decl_scope ();
18419 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
18420 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
18422 static void
18423 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
18425 dw_die_ref old_die;
18426 tree save_fn;
18427 tree context;
18428 int was_abstract;
18429 htab_t old_decl_loc_table;
18431 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
18432 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
18434 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18435 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18436 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
18437 return;
18439 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
18440 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
18441 get locations in abstract instantces. */
18442 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
18443 decl_loc_table = NULL;
18445 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
18446 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
18447 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18449 context = decl_class_context (decl);
18450 if (context)
18451 gen_type_die_for_member
18452 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
18455 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
18456 save_fn = current_function_decl;
18457 current_function_decl = decl;
18458 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
18460 was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
18461 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
18462 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
18463 if (! was_abstract)
18464 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
18466 current_function_decl = save_fn;
18467 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
18468 pop_cfun ();
18471 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
18472 htab_traverse.
18474 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
18475 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
18477 static int
18478 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18480 tree type;
18481 dw_die_ref die;
18483 type = (tree) *slot;
18484 die = lookup_type_die (type);
18485 if (die != NULL)
18486 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18487 return 1;
18490 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
18491 through htab_traverse.
18493 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
18494 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
18495 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
18497 static int
18498 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (void **slot,
18499 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18501 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
18502 dw_die_ref die;
18504 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
18505 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
18506 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
18507 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
18508 if (die)
18510 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
18511 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
18512 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (entry->var_decl);
18513 if (node && node->needed)
18515 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18516 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
18517 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
18518 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18521 return 1;
18524 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
18526 static void
18527 premark_used_types (void)
18529 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
18530 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
18533 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
18535 static void
18536 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
18538 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
18539 htab_traverse (types_used_by_vars_hash,
18540 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper, NULL);
18543 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
18544 block-local). */
18546 static void
18547 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18549 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18550 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18551 dw_die_ref subr_die;
18552 tree fn_arg_types;
18553 tree outer_scope;
18554 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18555 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
18556 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
18558 premark_used_types ();
18560 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
18561 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
18562 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
18563 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
18564 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
18566 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
18567 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
18569 origin = NULL;
18570 gcc_assert (!old_die);
18573 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
18574 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
18575 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
18576 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
18577 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
18578 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18579 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
18581 if (origin != NULL)
18583 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
18585 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
18586 inline function. */
18587 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
18588 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
18590 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18591 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
18593 else if (old_die)
18595 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18596 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
18598 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
18599 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
18600 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
18601 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
18602 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18604 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
18605 something we have already output. */
18606 return;
18609 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
18610 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
18611 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
18612 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
18613 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
18614 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
18615 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
18616 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
18617 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
18618 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
18619 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
18620 == (unsigned) s.line))))
18622 subr_die = old_die;
18624 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
18625 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
18626 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
18627 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
18628 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
18629 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18630 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
18632 else
18634 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18635 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
18636 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
18637 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
18638 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
18639 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18642 else
18644 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18646 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18647 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18649 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
18650 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18652 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
18653 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
18654 0, 0, context_die);
18657 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18658 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18659 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18661 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18664 if (declaration)
18666 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18668 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18670 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
18671 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
18672 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
18673 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18674 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
18676 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
18677 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
18678 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
18679 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
18681 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
18682 later reused to represent definition. */
18683 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18686 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18688 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
18690 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
18691 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
18692 else
18693 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
18695 else
18697 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
18698 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
18699 else
18700 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
18703 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
18704 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
18705 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18707 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18709 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18711 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
18713 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18714 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18716 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
18718 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
18719 current_function_funcdef_no);
18720 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
18721 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
18722 current_function_funcdef_no);
18723 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
18725 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18726 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
18727 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
18728 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
18729 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
18730 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
18731 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
18732 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
18733 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
18734 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
18735 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
18736 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
18739 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[current_funcdef_fde];
18741 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
18742 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
18743 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
18745 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
18746 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
18747 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
18749 #endif
18751 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
18752 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
18754 else
18755 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
18756 hot section and one for cold section, then use the hot/cold
18757 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
18759 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
18760 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
18761 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
18762 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
18764 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
18765 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
18766 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
18770 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18771 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
18772 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
18773 #endif
18775 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
18777 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
18778 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
18779 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
18780 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
18781 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
18782 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
18783 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
18784 function. */
18785 if (dwarf_version >= 3)
18787 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
18788 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
18790 else
18792 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
18793 if (list->dw_loc_next)
18794 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
18795 else
18796 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
18799 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
18800 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
18801 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
18802 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
18803 by this displacement. */
18804 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
18806 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
18807 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
18808 loc_list_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl, 2));
18811 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
18812 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18813 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
18815 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
18816 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
18817 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
18818 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
18819 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
18820 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
18821 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
18822 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
18823 an ellipsis at the end. */
18825 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
18826 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
18827 its formal parameters. */
18828 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18830 else if (declaration)
18831 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
18832 else
18834 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
18835 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
18836 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
18837 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
18838 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
18839 : NULL;
18841 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
18842 emit their relevant DIEs.
18844 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
18845 as well as it being a normal function.
18847 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
18848 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
18849 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
18850 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
18851 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
18852 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
18853 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
18854 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
18855 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
18856 children DIE.
18858 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
18859 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
18861 if (generic_decl_parm
18862 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
18863 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
18864 parm, subr_die,
18865 &parm);
18866 else if (parm)
18868 gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
18869 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
18872 if (generic_decl_parm)
18873 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
18876 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
18877 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
18878 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
18879 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
18880 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
18881 parameters at all. */
18882 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
18883 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
18885 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
18886 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
18887 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
18889 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
18890 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
18893 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
18894 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
18895 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
18897 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
18898 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
18899 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
18900 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
18901 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
18902 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
18903 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
18905 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
18906 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
18907 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
18908 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
18909 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
18910 constructor function. */
18911 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
18913 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
18914 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
18915 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
18917 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
18918 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
18920 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
18921 if (current_function_has_inlines)
18923 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
18924 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
18926 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
18927 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
18930 #endif
18932 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
18933 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18937 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
18939 static hashval_t
18940 common_block_die_table_hash (const void *x)
18942 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
18943 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
18946 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
18947 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
18949 static int
18950 common_block_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
18952 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
18953 const_dw_die_ref e = (const_dw_die_ref) y;
18954 return d->decl_id == e->decl_id && d->die_parent == e->die_parent;
18957 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
18958 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
18960 static void
18961 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
18963 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
18964 tree com_decl;
18965 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
18966 tree ultimate_origin;
18967 dw_die_ref var_die;
18968 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
18969 dw_die_ref origin_die;
18970 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
18971 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
18972 bool specialization_p = false;
18974 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
18975 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
18976 origin = ultimate_origin;
18977 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
18979 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
18980 of a data member. */
18981 if (com_decl)
18983 dw_die_ref com_die;
18984 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
18985 die_node com_die_arg;
18987 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
18988 if (var_die)
18990 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
18992 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2);
18993 if (loc)
18995 if (off)
18997 /* Optimize the common case. */
18998 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
18999 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
19000 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
19001 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
19002 == SYMBOL_REF)
19003 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
19004 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
19005 else
19006 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
19008 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19009 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19012 return;
19015 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
19016 common_block_die_table
19017 = htab_create_ggc (10, common_block_die_table_hash,
19018 common_block_die_table_eq, NULL);
19020 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
19021 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
19022 com_die = (dw_die_ref) htab_find (common_block_die_table, &com_die_arg);
19023 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
19024 if (com_die == NULL)
19026 const char *cnam
19027 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
19028 void **slot;
19030 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
19031 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
19032 if (loc)
19034 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19035 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
19036 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
19037 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
19039 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19040 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19041 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
19042 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
19043 slot = htab_find_slot (common_block_die_table, com_die, INSERT);
19044 *slot = (void *) com_die;
19046 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
19048 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19049 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
19050 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19052 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
19053 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
19054 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
19055 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
19056 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19057 if (loc)
19059 if (off)
19061 /* Optimize the common case. */
19062 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
19063 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
19064 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
19065 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
19066 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
19067 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
19068 else
19069 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
19071 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19073 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19074 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19075 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
19076 return;
19079 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
19080 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
19081 DIE for it again. Allow re-declarations of DECLs that are
19082 inside functions, though. */
19083 if (old_die && declaration && !local_scope_p (context_die))
19084 return;
19086 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
19087 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
19088 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
19089 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
19090 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
19091 else
19092 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
19094 origin_die = NULL;
19095 if (origin != NULL)
19096 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
19098 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
19099 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
19101 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
19102 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
19103 sharing them.
19105 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
19107 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
19108 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
19109 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
19110 declaration. */
19111 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
19112 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
19114 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
19115 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
19116 specialization_p = true;
19117 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
19119 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
19120 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
19122 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
19123 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
19125 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
19126 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
19128 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
19129 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
19132 else
19133 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
19135 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
19136 || (origin != NULL
19137 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
19138 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
19139 decl_function_context
19140 (decl_or_origin))))
19142 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
19144 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
19145 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19146 else
19147 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl_or_origin),
19148 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19151 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
19153 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
19154 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19156 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19157 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19159 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
19162 if (declaration)
19163 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19165 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration))
19166 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
19168 if (! declaration
19169 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
19170 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
19171 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
19172 already set. */
19173 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
19174 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
19175 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
19176 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
19177 to add it again. */
19178 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
19180 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
19181 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
19182 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
19183 else
19184 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die,
19185 decl_or_origin,
19186 DW_AT_location);
19187 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
19189 else
19190 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
19193 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
19195 static void
19196 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19198 dw_die_ref const_die;
19199 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19201 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
19202 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
19203 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, 1, 0, context_die);
19204 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
19205 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19206 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19207 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19208 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
19211 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
19213 static void
19214 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19216 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19217 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
19218 rtx insn;
19219 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19221 if (origin != NULL)
19222 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
19223 else
19224 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
19226 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
19227 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
19228 else
19230 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19232 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
19233 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
19234 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
19235 if (insn
19236 && (LABEL_P (insn)
19237 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
19238 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
19240 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
19241 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
19242 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
19243 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
19244 it if it ever does happen. */
19245 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
19247 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
19248 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
19253 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
19254 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
19255 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
19257 static inline void
19258 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
19260 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
19262 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19264 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
19265 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
19270 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
19271 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
19273 static inline void
19274 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
19276 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19278 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
19279 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19281 tree chain;
19283 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
19285 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
19286 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19287 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
19290 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
19292 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
19295 add_ranges (chain);
19296 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
19298 while (chain);
19299 add_ranges (NULL);
19301 else
19303 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
19304 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19305 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
19306 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
19307 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19308 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
19312 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
19314 static void
19315 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
19317 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
19319 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
19320 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
19322 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
19325 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
19327 static void
19328 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
19330 tree decl;
19332 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
19333 be abstract. */
19334 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
19336 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
19338 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
19339 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
19340 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
19341 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
19342 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
19344 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
19346 dw_die_ref subr_die
19347 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
19349 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
19350 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
19351 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
19352 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
19354 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
19355 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
19359 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
19361 static void
19362 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19364 dw_die_ref decl_die;
19366 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
19367 return;
19369 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
19370 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
19371 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
19372 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
19373 context_die);
19375 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
19377 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19378 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19379 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19382 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
19383 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19385 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19386 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19388 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19390 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
19391 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
19394 #if 0
19395 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
19396 Use modified_type_die instead.
19397 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
19398 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
19400 static void
19401 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19403 dw_die_ref ptr_die
19404 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19406 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
19407 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19408 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
19411 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
19412 Use modified_type_die instead.
19413 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
19414 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
19416 static void
19417 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19419 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19421 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
19422 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
19423 else
19424 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
19426 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
19427 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19428 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
19430 #endif
19432 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
19434 static void
19435 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19437 dw_die_ref ptr_die
19438 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
19439 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19441 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
19442 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
19443 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
19444 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
19447 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
19449 static dw_die_ref
19450 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
19452 dw_die_ref die;
19453 char producer[250];
19454 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
19455 int language;
19457 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
19459 if (filename)
19461 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
19462 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
19463 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
19464 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
19467 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
19469 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
19470 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
19471 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
19472 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
19473 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
19474 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
19475 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
19476 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19477 strcat (producer, " -g");
19478 #endif
19480 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
19482 language = DW_LANG_C89;
19483 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
19484 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
19485 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
19486 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
19487 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
19488 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
19489 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19491 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
19492 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
19493 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
19494 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
19495 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
19496 language = DW_LANG_Java;
19497 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
19498 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
19499 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
19500 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
19503 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
19505 switch (language)
19507 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
19508 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
19509 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
19510 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
19511 lowercases everything. */
19512 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
19513 break;
19514 default:
19515 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
19516 break;
19518 return die;
19521 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
19523 static void
19524 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
19526 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
19528 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
19529 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
19531 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
19532 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
19534 if (access == access_public_node)
19535 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
19536 else if (access == access_protected_node)
19537 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
19540 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
19542 static void
19543 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19545 tree member;
19546 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
19547 dw_die_ref child;
19549 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
19550 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
19551 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
19552 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
19553 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
19554 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
19555 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
19556 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
19557 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
19558 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
19559 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
19561 /* First output info about the base classes. */
19562 if (binfo)
19564 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
19565 int i;
19566 tree base;
19568 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
19569 gen_inheritance_die (base,
19570 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
19571 : access_public_node), context_die);
19574 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
19575 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
19577 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
19578 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
19579 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
19580 do put them in the right order. */
19582 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
19583 if (child)
19584 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
19585 else
19586 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
19589 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
19590 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
19592 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
19593 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
19594 continue;
19596 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
19597 if (child)
19598 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
19599 else
19600 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
19604 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
19605 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
19606 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
19608 static void
19609 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
19610 enum debug_info_usage usage)
19612 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19613 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
19614 int nested = 0;
19615 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
19616 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19617 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
19618 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
19619 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
19621 if (type_die && ! complete)
19622 return;
19624 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
19625 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19626 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
19627 nested = 1;
19629 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19631 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
19632 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
19634 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
19636 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
19637 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
19638 scope_die, type);
19639 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19640 if (old_die)
19641 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
19642 else
19643 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
19645 else
19646 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19648 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
19649 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
19650 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type))
19651 gen_generic_params_dies (type);
19653 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
19654 then give a list of members. */
19655 if (complete && !ns_decl)
19657 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
19658 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
19659 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19660 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
19661 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
19663 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19664 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19667 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
19668 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
19669 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
19670 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
19672 push_decl_scope (type);
19673 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
19674 pop_decl_scope ();
19676 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
19677 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
19679 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
19681 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
19682 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
19683 lookup_type_die (vtype));
19686 else
19688 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19690 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
19691 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19692 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
19693 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
19696 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
19697 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
19700 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
19702 static void
19703 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19705 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
19706 dw_die_ref subr_die
19707 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
19708 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19710 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
19711 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
19712 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
19713 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
19715 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
19716 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
19719 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
19721 static void
19722 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19724 dw_die_ref type_die;
19725 tree origin;
19727 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
19728 return;
19730 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
19731 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
19732 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19733 if (origin != NULL)
19734 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
19735 else
19737 tree type;
19739 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
19740 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
19742 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
19744 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
19745 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
19747 else
19749 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19751 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19753 Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
19754 an anonymous type, e.g:
19755 typedef struct {...} foo;
19756 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
19757 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
19758 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
19759 the C++ FE.
19761 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
19762 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
19763 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
19764 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
19765 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
19766 anonymous struct DIE. */
19767 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
19770 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
19771 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
19773 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
19774 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
19775 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
19776 created. */
19777 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19779 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
19782 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
19783 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
19785 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
19786 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
19789 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
19791 static void
19792 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
19793 dw_die_ref context_die,
19794 enum debug_info_usage usage)
19796 int need_pop;
19798 if (type == NULL_TREE
19799 || !is_tagged_type (type))
19800 return;
19802 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
19803 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
19804 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
19805 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
19806 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
19807 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
19808 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
19809 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19810 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
19812 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
19814 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
19815 return;
19817 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
19818 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
19819 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
19820 need_pop = 1;
19822 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
19823 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
19825 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
19826 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
19827 decls_for_scope. */
19828 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
19829 need_pop = 0;
19831 else
19833 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
19834 need_pop = 0;
19837 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
19839 /* This might have been written out by the call to
19840 declare_in_namespace. */
19841 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
19842 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
19844 else
19845 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
19847 if (need_pop)
19848 pop_decl_scope ();
19850 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
19851 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
19852 when appropriate. */
19855 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
19857 static void
19858 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
19859 enum debug_info_usage usage)
19861 struct array_descr_info info;
19863 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
19864 return;
19866 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
19867 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
19868 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
19870 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
19871 return;
19873 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
19874 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
19876 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
19877 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
19878 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
19879 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19880 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
19882 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19884 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
19885 return;
19888 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
19889 generate debug info for the typedef. */
19890 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19892 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
19893 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
19894 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
19895 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19896 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
19898 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
19899 return;
19902 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
19903 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
19904 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
19905 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info)
19906 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19908 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
19909 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19910 return;
19913 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
19914 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
19915 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
19916 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
19917 cloned type itself). */
19918 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
19919 type = type_main_variant (type);
19921 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
19922 return;
19924 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
19926 case ERROR_MARK:
19927 break;
19929 case POINTER_TYPE:
19930 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
19931 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
19932 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
19933 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
19934 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
19935 statement. */
19936 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19938 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
19939 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
19940 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
19941 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
19942 break;
19944 case OFFSET_TYPE:
19945 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
19946 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
19947 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
19948 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
19950 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
19951 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
19952 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
19954 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
19955 itself. */
19956 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
19957 break;
19959 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
19960 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
19961 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
19962 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
19963 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
19964 break;
19966 case METHOD_TYPE:
19967 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
19968 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
19969 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
19970 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
19971 break;
19973 case ARRAY_TYPE:
19974 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
19975 break;
19977 case VECTOR_TYPE:
19978 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
19979 break;
19981 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
19982 case RECORD_TYPE:
19983 case UNION_TYPE:
19984 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
19985 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
19986 return;
19988 case VOID_TYPE:
19989 case INTEGER_TYPE:
19990 case REAL_TYPE:
19991 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
19992 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
19993 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
19994 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
19995 break;
19997 case LANG_TYPE:
19998 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
20000 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20001 if (type_die == NULL)
20003 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
20004 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
20005 name = DECL_NAME (name);
20006 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die, type);
20007 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
20008 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
20011 break;
20013 default:
20014 gcc_unreachable ();
20017 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20020 static void
20021 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20023 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20026 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
20027 things which are local to the given block. */
20029 static void
20030 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
20032 int must_output_die = 0;
20033 bool inlined_func;
20035 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
20036 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
20037 return;
20039 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
20041 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
20042 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
20043 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
20044 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
20046 tree sub;
20048 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
20049 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
20051 return;
20054 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
20055 block. */
20056 if (inlined_func)
20057 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
20058 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
20059 must_output_die = 1;
20060 else
20062 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
20063 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
20064 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20065 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
20066 as being a "significant" one. */
20067 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
20068 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
20069 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
20070 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
20071 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
20072 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
20073 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
20074 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
20075 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
20076 must_output_die = 1;
20079 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
20080 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
20081 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
20082 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
20083 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
20084 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
20085 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
20086 if (must_output_die)
20088 if (inlined_func)
20090 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
20091 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
20092 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
20093 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
20094 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
20095 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
20096 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
20097 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
20099 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
20100 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
20101 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
20102 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
20103 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
20104 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
20106 else
20107 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
20109 else
20110 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
20113 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
20114 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
20115 static void
20116 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20118 dw_die_ref die;
20119 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20121 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
20122 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
20123 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
20124 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
20125 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
20126 else
20127 die = NULL;
20129 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
20130 add_child_die (context_die, die);
20131 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
20132 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
20133 stmt, context_die);
20134 else
20135 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
20138 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
20139 all of its sub-blocks. */
20141 static void
20142 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
20144 tree decl;
20145 unsigned int i;
20146 tree subblocks;
20148 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
20149 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
20150 return;
20152 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
20153 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
20154 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
20155 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
20156 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
20157 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
20158 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
20159 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
20160 context_die);
20162 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
20163 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20164 return;
20166 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
20167 therein) of this block. */
20168 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
20169 subblocks != NULL;
20170 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
20171 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
20174 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
20176 static inline int
20177 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
20179 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
20180 return 1;
20182 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
20183 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
20184 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
20185 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
20186 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
20187 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
20188 return 1;
20190 return 0;
20193 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
20194 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
20195 constructs like:
20197 typedef struct {...} foo;
20199 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
20200 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
20201 struct type. */
20203 static bool
20204 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
20206 if (decl == NULL_TREE
20207 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
20208 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
20209 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
20210 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
20211 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
20212 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
20213 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
20214 || !is_cxx ())
20215 return FALSE;
20217 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
20218 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
20219 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
20220 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
20223 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
20225 static inline dw_die_ref
20226 get_context_die (tree context)
20228 if (context)
20230 /* Find die that represents this context. */
20231 if (TYPE_P (context))
20232 return force_type_die (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context));
20233 else
20234 return force_decl_die (context);
20236 return comp_unit_die;
20239 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
20241 static dw_die_ref
20242 force_decl_die (tree decl)
20244 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20245 unsigned saved_external_flag;
20246 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
20247 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20248 if (!decl_die)
20250 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
20252 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20253 if (decl_die)
20254 return decl_die;
20256 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
20258 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20259 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
20260 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
20261 declaration die. */
20262 save_fn = current_function_decl;
20263 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
20264 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
20265 current_function_decl = save_fn;
20266 break;
20268 case VAR_DECL:
20269 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
20270 gen_decl_die() call. */
20271 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
20272 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
20273 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
20274 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
20275 break;
20277 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
20278 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20279 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20280 else
20281 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
20282 decl_die = comp_unit_die;
20283 break;
20285 default:
20286 gcc_unreachable ();
20289 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
20290 if (!decl_die)
20291 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20292 gcc_assert (decl_die);
20295 return decl_die;
20298 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
20299 always returned. */
20301 static dw_die_ref
20302 force_type_die (tree type)
20304 dw_die_ref type_die;
20306 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20307 if (!type_die)
20309 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20311 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
20312 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
20313 gcc_assert (type_die);
20315 return type_die;
20318 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
20319 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
20321 static dw_die_ref
20322 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
20324 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
20325 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
20326 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20327 /* Force out the namespace. */
20328 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
20330 return context_die;
20333 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
20334 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
20336 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
20337 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
20339 static dw_die_ref
20340 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
20342 dw_die_ref ns_context;
20344 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20345 return context_die;
20347 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
20348 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
20349 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
20350 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
20351 return context_die;
20353 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
20355 if (ns_context != context_die)
20357 if (is_fortran ())
20358 return ns_context;
20359 if (DECL_P (thing))
20360 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
20361 else
20362 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
20364 return context_die;
20367 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
20369 static void
20370 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20372 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
20374 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
20375 they are an alias of. */
20376 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
20378 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
20379 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
20380 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
20381 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
20382 context_die, decl);
20383 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
20384 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20386 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
20387 if (name)
20388 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
20390 else
20391 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
20392 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20393 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20394 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
20396 else
20398 /* Output a namespace alias. */
20400 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
20401 dw_die_ref origin_die
20402 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
20404 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
20405 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20406 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
20407 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
20408 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
20409 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
20410 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
20411 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
20415 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
20417 static void
20418 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20420 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20421 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
20423 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
20424 return;
20426 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
20428 case ERROR_MARK:
20429 break;
20431 case CONST_DECL:
20432 if (!is_fortran ())
20434 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
20435 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
20436 break;
20439 /* Emit its type. */
20440 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
20442 /* And its containing namespace. */
20443 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
20445 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
20446 break;
20448 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20449 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
20450 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
20451 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
20452 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
20453 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
20454 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
20455 break;
20457 #if 0
20458 /* FIXME */
20459 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
20460 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
20461 if (current_function_decl != decl)
20462 /* This is only a declaration. */;
20463 #endif
20465 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
20466 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
20467 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
20468 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
20469 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
20471 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
20472 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
20473 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
20474 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
20475 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
20476 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
20477 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
20478 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
20479 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20481 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
20482 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
20485 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
20486 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20488 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
20489 have described its return type. */
20490 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
20492 /* And its virtual context. */
20493 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20494 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
20496 /* And its containing type. */
20497 if (!origin)
20498 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
20499 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
20500 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
20502 /* And its containing namespace. */
20503 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
20506 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
20507 if (decl)
20508 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
20509 break;
20511 case TYPE_DECL:
20512 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20513 actual typedefs. */
20514 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20515 break;
20517 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
20518 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
20519 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
20520 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
20521 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
20522 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
20523 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
20524 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
20525 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
20526 case. */
20527 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20528 break;
20530 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
20531 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
20532 else
20533 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
20534 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
20535 break;
20537 case LABEL_DECL:
20538 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
20539 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
20540 break;
20542 case VAR_DECL:
20543 case RESULT_DECL:
20544 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20545 variable declarations or definitions. */
20546 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20547 break;
20549 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
20550 object. */
20551 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
20552 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
20553 else
20554 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
20556 /* And its containing type. */
20557 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
20558 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
20559 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
20561 /* And its containing namespace. */
20562 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
20564 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
20565 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
20566 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
20567 function. */
20568 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
20569 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
20570 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
20571 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
20572 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
20573 context_die);
20574 else
20575 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
20576 break;
20578 case FIELD_DECL:
20579 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
20580 anonymous unions and structs. */
20581 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
20582 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
20583 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
20585 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
20586 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
20588 break;
20590 case PARM_DECL:
20591 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
20592 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
20593 else
20594 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
20595 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
20596 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
20597 context_die);
20598 break;
20600 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
20601 case IMPORTED_DECL:
20602 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20603 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
20604 break;
20606 default:
20607 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
20608 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
20609 break;
20613 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
20614 compilation proper has finished. */
20616 static void
20617 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
20619 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
20620 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
20621 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
20622 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
20623 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
20624 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20627 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
20628 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
20629 static void
20630 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
20632 if (!local)
20633 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20636 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
20637 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
20638 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
20639 that DECL belongs to.
20640 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
20641 static void
20642 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
20643 tree name,
20644 tree lexical_block,
20645 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
20647 expanded_location xloc;
20648 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
20649 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
20651 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
20653 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20654 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
20655 gcc_assert (decl);
20657 else
20658 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
20660 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
20662 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
20663 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
20664 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
20665 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
20666 if (!at_import_die)
20668 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
20669 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
20670 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
20671 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
20674 else
20676 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20677 if (!at_import_die)
20679 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
20680 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
20681 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
20683 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
20685 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
20686 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
20687 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
20688 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
20689 return;
20690 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
20691 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
20693 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
20697 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20699 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20700 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
20701 lexical_block_die,
20702 lexical_block);
20703 else
20704 return;
20706 else
20707 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
20708 lexical_block_die,
20709 lexical_block);
20711 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
20712 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
20713 if (name)
20714 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
20715 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
20716 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
20719 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
20720 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
20721 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
20722 importing whole module. */
20724 static void
20725 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
20726 bool child)
20728 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
20729 dw_die_ref scope_die;
20731 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20732 return;
20734 gcc_assert (decl);
20736 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
20737 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
20738 itself. */
20740 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
20741 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
20742 if (context
20743 && TYPE_P (context)
20744 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
20745 return;
20747 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20748 return;
20750 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
20752 if (child)
20754 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
20755 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
20756 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
20757 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
20760 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
20761 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
20765 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
20767 void
20768 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
20770 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
20772 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
20774 case ERROR_MARK:
20775 return;
20777 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20778 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
20779 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
20780 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
20781 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
20782 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
20783 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
20784 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
20785 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
20786 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
20787 with the definition of the function.
20789 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
20790 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
20791 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
20792 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
20793 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
20794 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
20795 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
20796 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
20797 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
20798 that they *are* definitions).
20800 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
20801 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
20802 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
20803 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
20804 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
20805 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
20806 return;
20808 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
20809 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
20810 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
20811 if (decl_function_context (decl)
20812 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
20813 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20814 context_die = NULL;
20815 break;
20817 case VAR_DECL:
20818 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
20819 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
20820 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
20821 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
20822 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
20823 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
20824 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
20825 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
20826 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
20827 return;
20829 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
20830 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
20831 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
20833 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20834 variable declarations or definitions. */
20835 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20836 return;
20837 break;
20839 case CONST_DECL:
20840 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20841 return;
20842 if (!is_fortran ())
20843 return;
20844 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
20845 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
20846 break;
20848 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
20849 case IMPORTED_DECL:
20850 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20851 return;
20852 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
20853 return;
20854 break;
20856 case TYPE_DECL:
20857 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
20858 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
20859 return;
20861 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
20862 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
20863 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
20865 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
20866 comparisons have. */
20867 if (is_cxx ()
20868 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
20869 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
20870 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
20872 return;
20875 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
20876 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20877 return;
20879 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
20880 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
20881 if (decl_function_context (decl))
20882 context_die = NULL;
20884 break;
20886 default:
20887 return;
20890 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
20893 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
20895 static void
20896 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
20898 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20900 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
20903 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
20904 a lexical block. */
20906 static void
20907 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20908 unsigned int blocknum)
20910 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
20911 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
20914 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
20915 lexical block. */
20917 static void
20918 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
20920 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
20921 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
20924 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
20925 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
20927 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
20928 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
20929 we may end up calling them anyway. */
20931 static bool
20932 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
20934 tree decl;
20935 unsigned int i;
20937 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
20938 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
20939 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
20940 return 0;
20941 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
20943 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
20944 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
20945 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
20946 return 0;
20949 return 1;
20952 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
20954 static int
20955 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
20957 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p1 =
20958 (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p1_p;
20959 const char *const p2 = (const char *) p2_p;
20960 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
20963 static hashval_t
20964 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
20966 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p = (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p_p;
20967 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
20970 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
20971 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
20972 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
20973 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
20974 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
20975 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
20976 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
20977 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
20978 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
20979 all searches. */
20981 static struct dwarf_file_data *
20982 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
20984 void ** slot;
20985 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
20987 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
20988 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
20989 if (file_table_last_lookup
20990 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
20991 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
20992 return file_table_last_lookup;
20994 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
20995 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
20996 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
20997 if (*slot)
20998 return (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
21000 created = ggc_alloc_dwarf_file_data ();
21001 created->filename = file_name;
21002 created->emitted_number = 0;
21003 *slot = created;
21004 return created;
21007 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
21008 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
21009 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
21010 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
21011 types, which may include filenames. */
21013 static int
21014 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
21016 if (! fd->emitted_number)
21018 if (last_emitted_file)
21019 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
21020 else
21021 fd->emitted_number = 1;
21022 last_emitted_file = fd;
21024 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21026 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
21027 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
21028 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
21029 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
21033 return fd->emitted_number;
21036 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
21037 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
21038 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
21040 static void
21041 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
21043 die_arg_entry entry;
21045 if (!die || !arg)
21046 return;
21048 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
21049 tmpl_value_parm_die_table
21050 = VEC_alloc (die_arg_entry, gc, 32);
21052 entry.die = die;
21053 entry.arg = arg;
21054 VEC_safe_push (die_arg_entry, gc,
21055 tmpl_value_parm_die_table,
21056 &entry);
21059 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
21060 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
21061 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
21063 static void
21064 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
21066 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
21068 unsigned i;
21069 die_arg_entry *e;
21071 for (i = 0;
21072 VEC_iterate (die_arg_entry, tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e);
21073 i++)
21074 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
21079 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
21081 static void
21082 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
21084 dw_die_ref die;
21085 dw_attr_ref attr;
21086 const char *dname;
21088 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
21089 if (!die)
21090 return;
21092 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
21093 if (!dname)
21094 return;
21096 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
21097 if (attr)
21099 struct indirect_string_node *node;
21101 node = find_AT_string (dname);
21102 /* replace the string. */
21103 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
21106 else
21107 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
21110 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a direct function call.
21111 Make an entry into the direct call table, recording the point of call
21112 and a reference to the target function's debug entry. */
21114 static void
21115 dwarf2out_direct_call (tree targ)
21117 dcall_entry e;
21118 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (targ);
21120 /* If this is a clone, use the abstract origin as the target. */
21121 if (origin)
21122 targ = origin;
21124 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
21125 e.poc_decl = current_function_decl;
21126 e.targ_die = force_decl_die (targ);
21127 VEC_safe_push (dcall_entry, gc, dcall_table, &e);
21129 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
21130 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
21133 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a struct vcall_insn). */
21135 static hashval_t
21136 vcall_insn_table_hash (const void *x)
21138 return (hashval_t) ((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid;
21141 /* Return nonzero if insn_uid of struct vcall_insn *X is the same as
21142 insnd_uid of *Y. */
21144 static int
21145 vcall_insn_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
21147 return (((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid
21148 == ((const struct vcall_insn *) y)->insn_uid);
21151 /* Associate VTABLE_SLOT with INSN_UID in the VCALL_INSN_TABLE. */
21153 static void
21154 store_vcall_insn (unsigned int vtable_slot, int insn_uid)
21156 struct vcall_insn *item = ggc_alloc_vcall_insn ();
21157 struct vcall_insn **slot;
21159 gcc_assert (item);
21160 item->insn_uid = insn_uid;
21161 item->vtable_slot = vtable_slot;
21162 slot = (struct vcall_insn **)
21163 htab_find_slot_with_hash (vcall_insn_table, &item,
21164 (hashval_t) insn_uid, INSERT);
21165 *slot = item;
21168 /* Return the VTABLE_SLOT associated with INSN_UID. */
21170 static unsigned int
21171 lookup_vcall_insn (unsigned int insn_uid)
21173 struct vcall_insn item;
21174 struct vcall_insn *p;
21176 item.insn_uid = insn_uid;
21177 item.vtable_slot = 0;
21178 p = (struct vcall_insn *) htab_find_with_hash (vcall_insn_table,
21179 (void *) &item,
21180 (hashval_t) insn_uid);
21181 if (p == NULL)
21182 return (unsigned int) -1;
21183 return p->vtable_slot;
21187 /* Called when lowering indirect calls to RTL. We make a note of INSN_UID
21188 and the OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN from ADDR. For C++ virtual calls, the token
21189 is the vtable slot index that we will need to put in the virtual call
21190 table later. */
21192 static void
21193 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree addr, int insn_uid)
21195 if (is_cxx() && TREE_CODE (addr) == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
21197 tree token = OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (addr);
21198 if (TREE_CODE (token) == INTEGER_CST)
21199 store_vcall_insn (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (token), insn_uid);
21203 /* Called when scheduling RTL, when a CALL_INSN is split. Copies the
21204 OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN previously associated with OLD_INSN and associates it
21205 with NEW_INSN. */
21207 static void
21208 dwarf2out_copy_call_info (rtx old_insn, rtx new_insn)
21210 unsigned int vtable_slot = lookup_vcall_insn (INSN_UID (old_insn));
21212 if (vtable_slot != (unsigned int) -1)
21213 store_vcall_insn (vtable_slot, INSN_UID (new_insn));
21216 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a virtual function call.
21217 Make an entry into the virtual call table, recording the point of call
21218 and the slot index of the vtable entry used to call the virtual member
21219 function. The slot index was associated with the INSN_UID during the
21220 lowering to RTL. */
21222 static void
21223 dwarf2out_virtual_call (int insn_uid)
21225 unsigned int vtable_slot = lookup_vcall_insn (insn_uid);
21226 vcall_entry e;
21228 if (vtable_slot == (unsigned int) -1)
21229 return;
21231 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
21232 e.vtable_slot = vtable_slot;
21233 VEC_safe_push (vcall_entry, gc, vcall_table, &e);
21235 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
21236 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
21239 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
21240 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
21241 our lookup table. */
21243 static void
21244 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
21246 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
21247 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
21248 rtx next_real;
21249 static const char *last_label;
21250 static const char *last_postcall_label;
21251 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
21252 tree decl;
21254 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
21255 return;
21257 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
21258 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
21259 don't do anything. */
21260 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
21261 return;
21263 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
21264 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
21265 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
21266 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
21267 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
21268 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
21270 last_label = NULL;
21271 last_postcall_label = NULL;
21274 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
21275 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
21276 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
21277 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
21278 if (newloc == NULL)
21279 return;
21281 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
21282 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
21283 create a new label and emit it. */
21284 if (last_label == NULL)
21286 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
21287 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
21288 loclabel_num++;
21289 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
21292 if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
21293 newloc->label = last_label;
21294 else
21296 if (!last_postcall_label)
21298 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
21299 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
21301 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
21304 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
21305 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
21308 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
21309 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
21310 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
21311 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
21313 static void
21314 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
21316 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
21317 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
21319 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
21322 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
21323 and record information relating to this source line, in
21324 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
21326 static void
21327 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
21328 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
21330 static bool last_is_stmt = true;
21332 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
21333 && line != 0)
21335 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
21337 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
21339 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
21340 if (flag_debug_asm)
21341 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
21342 filename, line);
21344 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21346 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
21347 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0", file_num, line);
21348 if (is_stmt != last_is_stmt)
21350 fprintf (asm_out_file, " is_stmt %d", is_stmt ? 1 : 0);
21351 last_is_stmt = is_stmt;
21353 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
21354 fprintf (asm_out_file, " discriminator %d", discriminator);
21355 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
21357 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
21358 line_info_table_in_use++;
21360 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
21362 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
21363 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
21364 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
21365 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
21367 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
21368 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
21369 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
21371 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21372 separate_line_info_table
21373 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_separate_line_info_entry,
21374 separate_line_info_table,
21375 separate_line_info_table_allocated);
21376 memset (separate_line_info_table
21377 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
21379 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
21380 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
21383 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
21384 line_info
21385 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
21386 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
21387 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
21388 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
21390 else
21392 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
21394 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
21395 line_info_table_in_use);
21397 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
21398 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
21400 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21401 line_info_table
21402 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_line_info_entry, line_info_table,
21403 line_info_table_allocated);
21404 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
21405 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
21408 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
21409 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
21410 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
21411 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
21416 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
21418 static void
21419 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
21421 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
21423 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
21424 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
21426 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
21427 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
21430 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21432 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
21434 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21435 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
21436 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
21437 lineno);
21439 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
21443 /* Record the end of a source file. */
21445 static void
21446 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21448 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
21449 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
21450 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
21452 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21454 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21455 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
21459 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
21460 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
21461 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
21463 static void
21464 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
21465 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21467 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21469 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21470 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
21471 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
21472 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
21476 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
21477 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
21478 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
21480 static void
21481 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
21482 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21484 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21486 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21487 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
21488 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
21489 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
21493 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
21495 static void
21496 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21498 /* Allocate the file_table. */
21499 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
21500 file_table_eq, NULL);
21502 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
21503 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
21504 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
21506 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
21507 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
21508 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
21510 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
21511 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
21513 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
21514 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_die_ref
21515 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
21516 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21517 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
21518 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
21520 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
21521 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_line_info_entry
21522 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT);
21523 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
21525 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
21526 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
21528 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
21529 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
21530 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
21532 /* Allocate the table that maps insn UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
21533 vcall_insn_table = htab_create_ggc (10, vcall_insn_table_hash,
21534 vcall_insn_table_eq, NULL);
21536 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
21537 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
21538 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
21539 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
21540 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
21541 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
21542 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
21544 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
21546 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
21548 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
21549 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21550 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
21551 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21552 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
21553 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21554 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
21555 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21556 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
21557 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21558 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
21559 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21560 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
21561 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21562 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
21563 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21564 debug_dcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION,
21565 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21566 debug_vcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION,
21567 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21568 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
21569 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
21570 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
21571 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21572 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
21573 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
21575 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
21576 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
21577 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21578 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21579 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
21580 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21581 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
21583 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
21584 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21585 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
21586 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21587 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
21588 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21589 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
21590 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
21591 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
21592 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
21593 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
21594 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
21596 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21598 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21599 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
21600 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21601 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
21604 switch_to_section (text_section);
21605 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
21606 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21608 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
21609 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
21610 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
21615 /* Called before cgraph_optimize starts outputtting functions, variables
21616 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
21618 static void
21619 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
21621 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
21623 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
21624 if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS || (!flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions))
21625 #endif
21626 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
21630 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
21631 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
21633 static int
21634 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21636 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
21638 if (node->label && node->refcount)
21640 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
21641 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
21642 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
21645 return 1;
21648 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
21649 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
21651 static void
21652 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
21654 dw_die_ref c;
21656 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
21657 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
21659 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
21661 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
21662 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
21664 static void
21665 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
21667 dw_die_ref c;
21669 if (die->die_mark)
21670 die->die_mark = 0;
21671 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
21674 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
21675 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
21677 static void
21678 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
21680 dw_attr_ref a;
21681 unsigned ix;
21683 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
21685 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
21687 /* A reference to another DIE.
21688 Make sure that it will get emitted.
21689 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
21690 if (dwarf_version < 4
21691 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
21692 || a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die->die_id.die_type_node == NULL)
21693 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
21695 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
21696 accounts properly for it. */
21697 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
21698 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
21703 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
21704 to DIE's children. */
21706 static void
21707 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
21709 dw_die_ref c;
21711 if (die->die_mark == 0)
21713 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
21714 die->die_mark = 1;
21716 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
21717 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
21718 if (die->die_parent)
21719 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
21721 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
21722 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
21724 /* If this node is a specification,
21725 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
21726 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
21727 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
21730 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
21732 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
21733 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
21734 die->die_mark = 2;
21736 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
21737 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
21738 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
21739 for all type definitions. */
21740 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
21741 || (dwarf_version >= 4
21742 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
21743 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
21744 else
21745 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
21749 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
21750 and if so, mark them. */
21752 static void
21753 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
21755 dw_die_ref c;
21757 if (die->die_mark == 2)
21758 return;
21760 switch (die->die_tag)
21762 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
21763 case DW_TAG_union_type:
21764 case DW_TAG_class_type:
21765 break;
21767 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
21768 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
21769 || die->die_definition != NULL)
21770 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
21771 return;
21773 default:
21774 return;
21777 /* Mark children. */
21778 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
21781 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
21783 static void
21784 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
21786 dw_die_ref c;
21788 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
21789 children have been marked as well. */
21790 if (die->die_mark == 2)
21791 return;
21793 switch (die->die_tag)
21795 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
21796 case DW_TAG_union_type:
21797 case DW_TAG_class_type:
21798 if (die->die_perennial_p)
21799 break;
21801 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
21802 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
21803 break;
21805 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
21806 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
21807 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
21808 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
21809 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
21810 if (c)
21811 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
21813 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
21814 return;
21816 case DW_TAG_const_type:
21817 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
21818 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
21819 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
21820 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
21821 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
21822 case DW_TAG_typedef:
21823 case DW_TAG_array_type:
21824 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
21825 case DW_TAG_friend:
21826 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
21827 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
21828 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
21829 case DW_TAG_string_type:
21830 case DW_TAG_set_type:
21831 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
21832 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
21833 case DW_TAG_file_type:
21834 if (die->die_perennial_p)
21835 break;
21837 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
21838 return;
21840 default:
21841 /* Mark everything else. */
21842 break;
21845 if (die->die_mark == 0)
21847 die->die_mark = 1;
21849 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
21850 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
21853 die->die_mark = 2;
21855 /* Mark children. */
21856 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
21859 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
21860 attributes. */
21862 static void
21863 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
21865 dw_attr_ref a;
21866 unsigned ix;
21868 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
21869 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
21871 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
21872 s->refcount++;
21873 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
21874 twice in the hash table. */
21875 if (s->refcount
21876 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
21878 void ** slot;
21879 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
21880 htab_hash_string (s->str),
21881 INSERT);
21882 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
21883 *slot = s;
21888 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
21890 static void
21891 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
21893 dw_die_ref c;
21895 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
21896 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
21898 if (! die->die_child)
21899 return;
21901 c = die->die_child;
21902 do {
21903 dw_die_ref prev = c;
21904 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
21905 if (c == die->die_child)
21907 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
21908 if (prev == c)
21909 /* No marked children at all. */
21910 die->die_child = NULL;
21911 else
21913 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
21914 die->die_child = prev;
21916 return;
21919 if (c != prev->die_sib)
21920 prev->die_sib = c;
21921 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
21922 } while (c != die->die_child);
21925 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
21926 htab_traverse. Clear .debug_str strings that we haven't already
21927 decided to emit. */
21929 static int
21930 prune_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21932 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
21934 if (!node->label || !node->refcount)
21935 htab_clear_slot (debug_str_hash, h);
21937 return 1;
21940 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
21942 static void
21943 prune_unused_types (void)
21945 unsigned int i;
21946 limbo_die_node *node;
21947 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
21948 pubname_ref pub;
21949 dcall_entry *dcall;
21951 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
21952 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
21953 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
21954 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21955 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
21956 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21957 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
21958 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
21960 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
21961 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
21963 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
21964 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
21965 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21966 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
21967 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21969 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
21970 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
21973 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
21974 pubname_table or arange_table. */
21975 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
21976 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
21977 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
21978 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
21980 /* Mark nodes referenced from the direct call table. */
21981 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, dcall); i++)
21982 prune_unused_types_mark (dcall->targ_die, 1);
21984 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
21985 if (debug_str_hash && debug_str_hash_forced)
21986 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, prune_indirect_string, NULL);
21987 else if (debug_str_hash)
21988 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
21989 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
21990 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21991 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
21992 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21993 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
21995 /* Leave the marks clear. */
21996 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
21997 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21998 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
21999 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22000 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
22003 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
22004 the file table. */
22005 static int
22006 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
22008 bool *p = (bool *) param;
22009 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
22010 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
22012 *p = true;
22013 return 0;
22015 return 1;
22018 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
22020 static hashval_t
22021 htab_ct_hash (const void *of)
22023 hashval_t h;
22024 const comdat_type_node *const type_node = (const comdat_type_node *) of;
22026 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
22027 return h;
22030 static int
22031 htab_ct_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
22033 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_1 = (const comdat_type_node *) of1;
22034 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_2 = (const comdat_type_node *) of2;
22036 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
22037 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
22040 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
22041 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
22042 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
22043 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
22044 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
22045 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
22047 static inline void
22048 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
22050 unsigned ix = VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
22051 dw_attr_node linkage = *VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
22053 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
22054 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
22056 while (--ix > 0)
22058 dw_attr_node *prev = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
22060 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
22061 break;
22064 if (ix != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr) - 1)
22066 VEC_pop (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
22067 VEC_quick_insert (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, &linkage);
22071 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
22072 one CONST_STRING, return non-zero if not successful. Similarly verify that
22073 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
22075 static int
22076 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22078 rtx rtl = *addr;
22080 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
22082 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
22083 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
22084 tree tlen = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, len - 1);
22085 TREE_TYPE (t)
22086 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
22087 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
22088 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
22089 return 1;
22090 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
22091 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
22092 *addr = rtl;
22093 return 0;
22096 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
22097 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
22098 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
22099 return 1;
22101 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
22102 && for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), resolve_one_addr, NULL))
22103 return 1;
22105 return 0;
22108 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
22109 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
22110 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
22112 static bool
22113 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
22115 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
22116 if (((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr || loc->dtprel)
22117 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
22118 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_implicit_value
22119 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
22120 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr, NULL)))
22121 return false;
22122 return true;
22125 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
22126 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
22127 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
22128 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
22129 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
22130 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
22132 static void
22133 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
22135 dw_die_ref c;
22136 dw_attr_ref a;
22137 dw_loc_list_ref *curr;
22138 unsigned ix;
22140 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
22141 switch (AT_class (a))
22143 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
22144 curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
22145 while (*curr)
22147 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
22149 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
22150 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
22152 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
22153 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
22155 *curr = next;
22157 else
22158 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
22160 if (!AT_loc_list (a))
22162 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
22163 ix--;
22165 break;
22166 case dw_val_class_loc:
22167 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (AT_loc (a)))
22169 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
22170 ix--;
22172 break;
22173 case dw_val_class_addr:
22174 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
22175 && resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr, NULL))
22177 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
22178 ix--;
22180 break;
22181 default:
22182 break;
22185 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
22188 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
22189 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
22191 static void
22192 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
22194 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
22195 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
22196 htab_t comdat_type_table;
22197 dw_die_ref die = 0;
22198 unsigned int i;
22200 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
22202 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
22203 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
22204 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, remap_debug_filename (filename));
22205 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
22206 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
22207 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
22209 bool p = false;
22210 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
22211 if (p)
22212 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
22215 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list); i++)
22217 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
22218 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->die,
22219 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->variable,
22220 DW_AT_location);
22223 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
22224 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
22225 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
22226 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
22227 instance. */
22228 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
22230 next_node = node->next;
22231 die = node->die;
22233 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
22235 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
22237 if (origin)
22238 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
22239 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
22241 else if (seen_error ())
22242 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
22243 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
22244 else
22246 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
22247 nested function can be optimized away, which results
22248 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
22249 with the return type of that nested function. Force
22250 this to be a child of the containing function.
22252 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
22253 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
22254 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
22255 the function is likely unreachable too. */
22256 tree context = NULL_TREE;
22258 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
22260 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
22261 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
22262 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
22263 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
22265 gcc_assert (context
22266 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
22267 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
22269 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
22270 if (origin)
22271 add_child_die (origin, die);
22272 else
22273 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
22278 limbo_die_list = NULL;
22280 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die);
22282 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
22284 tree decl = node->created_for;
22285 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
22287 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
22288 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
22292 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
22294 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
22295 emit full debugging info for them. */
22296 retry_incomplete_types ();
22298 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
22299 prune_unused_types ();
22301 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
22302 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
22303 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
22304 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
22306 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
22307 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
22309 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die);
22311 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
22312 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
22313 limbo die list. */
22314 limbo_die_list = NULL;
22316 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
22317 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
22318 references to the main compile unit). */
22319 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22320 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
22321 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die);
22323 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
22324 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
22325 referenced. Prune them. */
22326 prune_unused_types ();
22329 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
22330 that have children. */
22331 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
22332 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22333 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
22334 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22335 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
22337 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
22338 switch_to_section (text_section);
22339 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
22340 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
22342 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
22343 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
22346 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
22347 in .text. */
22348 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
22349 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22351 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
22352 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
22355 else
22357 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
22358 bool range_list_added = false;
22360 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
22361 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
22362 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
22363 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
22364 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
22365 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
22366 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
22368 if (text_section_used)
22369 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
22370 text_end_label, &range_list_added);
22371 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && cold_text_section_used)
22372 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
22373 cold_end_label, &range_list_added);
22375 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
22377 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
22379 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
22381 if (!fde->in_std_section)
22382 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die,
22383 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
22384 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
22385 &range_list_added);
22386 if (!fde->cold_in_std_section)
22387 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die,
22388 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
22389 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
22390 &range_list_added);
22392 else if (!fde->in_std_section)
22393 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22394 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added);
22397 if (range_list_added)
22398 add_ranges (NULL);
22401 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
22402 if (have_location_lists)
22404 /* Output the location lists info. */
22405 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
22406 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
22407 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22408 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
22409 output_location_lists (die);
22412 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22413 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
22414 debug_line_section_label);
22416 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22417 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
22419 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
22420 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
22421 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22422 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
22424 comdat_type_table = htab_create (100, htab_ct_hash, htab_ct_eq, NULL);
22425 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22427 void **slot = htab_find_slot (comdat_type_table, ctnode, INSERT);
22429 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
22430 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
22431 continue;
22433 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
22434 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
22435 attributes. */
22436 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22437 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
22438 debug_line_section_label);
22440 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
22441 *slot = ctnode;
22443 htab_delete (comdat_type_table);
22445 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
22446 has been emitted. */
22447 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE);
22449 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
22450 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
22451 output_abbrev_section ();
22453 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
22454 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
22456 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
22457 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
22460 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
22461 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
22462 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
22463 simply won't look for the section. */
22464 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
22466 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
22467 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
22470 /* Output direct and virtual call tables if necessary. */
22471 if (!VEC_empty (dcall_entry, dcall_table))
22473 switch_to_section (debug_dcall_section);
22474 output_dcall_table ();
22476 if (!VEC_empty (vcall_entry, vcall_table))
22478 switch_to_section (debug_vcall_section);
22479 output_vcall_table ();
22482 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
22483 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
22484 if (fde_table_in_use)
22486 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
22487 output_aranges ();
22490 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
22491 if (ranges_table_in_use)
22493 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
22494 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
22495 output_ranges ();
22498 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
22499 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
22500 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
22501 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
22502 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
22503 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
22504 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
22506 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
22507 output_line_info ();
22510 /* Have to end the macro section. */
22511 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22513 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
22514 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
22517 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
22518 table too. */
22519 if (debug_str_hash)
22520 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
22522 #else
22524 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
22525 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
22527 0, /* init */
22528 0, /* finish */
22529 0, /* assembly_start */
22530 0, /* define */
22531 0, /* undef */
22532 0, /* start_source_file */
22533 0, /* end_source_file */
22534 0, /* begin_block */
22535 0, /* end_block */
22536 0, /* ignore_block */
22537 0, /* source_line */
22538 0, /* begin_prologue */
22539 0, /* end_prologue */
22540 0, /* begin_epilogue */
22541 0, /* end_epilogue */
22542 0, /* begin_function */
22543 0, /* end_function */
22544 0, /* function_decl */
22545 0, /* global_decl */
22546 0, /* type_decl */
22547 0, /* imported_module_or_decl */
22548 0, /* deferred_inline_function */
22549 0, /* outlining_inline_function */
22550 0, /* label */
22551 0, /* handle_pch */
22552 0, /* var_location */
22553 0, /* switch_text_section */
22554 0, /* direct_call */
22555 0, /* virtual_call_token */
22556 0, /* copy_call_info */
22557 0, /* virtual_call */
22558 0, /* set_name */
22559 0 /* start_end_main_source_file */
22562 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
22564 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"